Вы находитесь на странице: 1из 164

1

BIBLE ANALYSIS:

t, ,

THE ACTS OF THE APOSTLES

Grace Bible Institute

Fall 2012
Pastor Kevin Jeffrey, M.Div.,pastor Grace Bible Church, instructor


INTRODUCTION
Many of the heresies perpetuated in Christendom today derive from a misapplication from
these places: The Old Testament, the Gospels or the Book of Acts. A proper hermeneutic
(interpretation of Scripture) requires that the interpreter of Scripture lets the Bible speak (take it
literally). The result of a literal interpretation is an application to the proper recipients of
Scripture. This type of interpretation can best be seen in the diets of Scripture. In the Garden
of Eden, Adam and Eve enjoyed a total vegetation diet. Adams immediate descendants
enjoyed a meat diet. Under law, Israel was prohibited from eating certain animals with hooves
as well as certain sea animals. Today, believers can eat anything the believer can give thanks
for. Indeed, application of Scripture to the proper recipients is very important.

The book of Acts has been widely misinterpreted for this reason. Application for the Church is
being made for events that served as necessary for recipients of the early church. For example,
In Acts the eighth chapter, the Holy Spirit was conferred as the apostles laid hands on those
who had already believed in Samaria. Today, the Holy Spirit is not conferred by the laying on of
hands. The early church had gifts given for the purpose of legitimizing the message preached.
Those gifts were given on a temporary basis and are not in existence today.

A tremendous amount of division exist in the Church over disagreement about the transitory
nature of the book of Acts. There are many who reject the temporary nature of some of the
acts carried out in the early Church. A study of the book of Acts in context provides an objective
view of the events of the early Church. A study in the book will show that the Acts of the
Apostles transitioned Gods plan and purposes from the earthly ministry of Christ to Gods
plans for the Church in this present dispensation. We would hope that at the end of this quarter
that you would possess a clear understanding of the doctrines of Acts in their proper context.



2
I. ABOUT ACTS

A. Official title: Ho_ci Atootoov (Acts of the Apostles)

B. Author of the book is Luke the physican.
1. The author of the gospel of Luke. Acts 1:1-2; Lk. 1:1-4
2. A traveling companion of Paul. 2 Tim. 4:11; Col. 4:14; (ill. Acts. 16:10-17; 20:5-
21:18; 27:1; 28:16)
3. Luke is the only Gentile writer in the Bible. (Identified as a gentile in Col. 4:10-15)

C. Recipient of the letter is Theopholous, a believer who was a high-level
official in the Roman government to whom Dr. Luke had written previously to
inform about the life of Christ.

D. Time of the writing of the letter.
1. Westminster Dictionary of the Bible puts the date at 63 a.d.
2. Charles Ryrie (Ryrie Study Bible) puts the date at 61 a.d.
3. Merrill Tenney (New Testament Survey) puts the date at 60 or 61 A.D.


II. THE PURPOSE FOR THE LETTER.
To explain the transition from the earthly Ministry of Jesus presenting the Kingdom
from the Heavens to Israel to the establishment of the Church which included both
Jew and Gentiles and was built by those whom He chose.


III. THEMES COVERED IN ACTS.
A. The Kingdom of God. Acts 1:3; 8:12; 14:22

B. Transition from Judism to the Church.
1. Change in focus on the Kingdom from the heavens. Acts 1:6
2. Change in residency of the members of the Godhead. Acts1: 9; 2:2-4
3. Change in People of God. Acts 13:44-48
4. Temporary methods utilized in laying the foundation of the Church.
a. Laying on of Hands to receive the Holy Spirit. Acts 8:14-17
b. Baptizing in the Name of Jesus. Acts 19:5

C. The Church
1. Its origin.
2. Its doctrines.
3. Its names.
a. This Way Acts 9:2; 23:4
b. That Way Acts 19:9, 23
c. Sect Acts 24:5, 14; 28:22
d. Christians Acts 11:26
4. Its development.
3
a. Primarily Jewish for the first few years. Acts 11:19; Acts 10:28;
11:1-3
b. Gentiles added over the span of years.
5. Its leaders primarily Apostles. Acts 2:43; 8:14-17
6. Its place of meeting in homes (primarily). Acts 2:46; 8:3; 12:12

D. The Times and Seasons. Acts 1:7

E. The Nation Israel
1. Gods past dealings with them. Acts 7; 13
2. Their rejection of messiah. Acts 2:34-38; 7:51-52
3. Their synagogues/Temple. Acts 17:1; 18:19; 21:26
4. Their relationship with the Roman government. Acts 24:2-3
5. Their relationship to gentiles. Acts 10:10-14, 28; 21:28-29
6. Their religious practices. Acts 6:13; 13:15; 15:5; 24; 18:13; 21:20

F. The Word from God

G. Peter
1. His message at Pentecost. Acts 2:14-39
2. His messages after Pentecost. Acts 3:12-26
3. His entry to the Gentiles. Acts 10
4. His transitory connections
a. God not a respecter of persons. Acts 10:34-37
b. Gentiles not under law. Acts 15:7-10
H. Paul of Tarsus
1. His conversion. Acts 9:1-9
2. His Apostolic journeys.
a. First Apostolic Journey Acts 14
b. Second Apostolic Journey Acts 15:40-18:23
c. Third Apostolic Journey Acts 28:23-21:17
3. His Apologetics. Acts 26:16-18
4. His struggles. Acts 18:1-9; 23:7-11

I. The Gentiles
a. Their history. Acts 14:15-17
b. Their religion pagan. Acts 14:8-13; 17:22-26
c. Their superstitions (respect for and fear of the supernatural). Acts 19:18-19; 28:4-6

J. The Baptism of John. Acts 1:5; 10:36-37; 13:25

K. The Holy Spirit
1. His arrival.
2. His leading.
3. His Predominant in the Dispensation of Grace.
4. His energizing.
4

L. The Mosaic Law (Acts 6:13; 15:5, 24; 18:13

M. Repentance (Acts 2:38; 3:19; 8:22; 17:30)

N. Resurrection of Jesus (Acts 2:31; 23:6; 26:23)

O. Salvation (Acts 4:12; 13:26; 15:1)

P. Miracles
1. Signs
2. Wonders
3. Mighty powers

Q. The Apostles
a. Their unique powers Acts 3:1-11
b. Their laying on of Hands (Acts 8:14-17)
c. Their role in laying the foundation of the church. Acts 1:2

R. Grace (Acts 13:43; 15:11; 20:24)

S. Witnesses (Acts 16:2; 23:11; 26:22)



IV. VARIOUS OUTLINES OF THE BOOK OF ACTS.

A. Merrill C. Tenneys New Testament Survey.

I. Introduction 1:1-11
II. The Origin of the Church: Jerusalem 1:12-8:3
III. The Period of Transition: Samaria 8:4-11:18
IV. The Expansion to the Gentiles 11:19-21:16
The Pauline Mission: Antioch and the Empire
V. The Imprisonment and Defense of Paul: 21:17-28:31
Caesarea and Rome


B. Ungers Bible Handbook.

I. From Jerusalem to All Judea 1-7
II. To Samaria 8
III. To the Gentiles 9-12
IV. To the End of the Earth 13-28


5
C. Charles Ryrie, The Ryrie Study Bible

I. Christianity in Jerusalem. 1:1-8:3
II. Christianity in Palestine and Syria. 8:4-12:25
III. Christianity to the Uttermost Part of the World. 13:1-28:31


D. Kevin Jeffrey, pastor Bethesda Bible Church
I. The Churchs Foundation laid at Pentecost. 1-6
II. The Transition From Law to Grace Wrought With Challenges. 7-8
III. The Addition of The Gentiles Hastened The Transition
From Law To Grace 9-12
IV. The Conversion of Paul Instrumental in the Direction of
The Church 13-21
V. Pauline Apologetics Crucial to Development of the Church 22-28































6
CHAPTER 1


I. GOD RAISES THE CURTAINS ON THE NEXT SCENE IN HIS UNFOLDING PLAN AND
PURPOSES. CHAPTER 1
A. Dr. Luke covered the last scene of Gods unfolding plan and purposes in great detail in his
first letter to Theophilus (The Book of Luke). vs.1
1. Not much is known about the recipient of the book of Acts, Theophilus.
a. Theophilus name in Greek means one who is fond of God.
b. Theophilus, apparently, was a high official in the Roman government as
indicated by Lukes most excellent address to Theophilus in his first letter
was on par with that made to high officials. (ill. Acts 23:26; 24:2)
2. Lukes first discourse focused (generally concerning two areas of the Lords earthly
ministry:
a. The things that Jesus began to do.
He began to do miracles. Lk. 5:17-25; 6:17-19; 8:22-55
He began to incite the Jews. Lk. 4:23-30; 11:45-54; 13:10-17;
20:19-20
b. The things that Jesus began to teach.
He taught concerning the poor. Lk. (Lk. 4:18) 6:20-49
He taught concerning the Kingdom of God. (33x) Lk. 9:1; 16:16;
17:20
He taught concerning His death, burial and resurrection. Lk.
9:43-45; 18:31-34
He taught concerning the after life. Lk. 16:19-31
He taught concerning the Tribulation period. Lk. 21:7-28
He taught concerning the suffering and glorification of Messiah.
Lk. 24:24-27; 44-48
4. Luke validates the time frame of events covered in his first letter. vs. 1b-2a
a. Lukesfirst letter begins with the things Jesus began to do and teach.
b. Lukes first letter ends with the Lords giving of injunctions to His
Apostles. Lk. 24:49 (Acts 1:4)
c. Lukes record extends to the day the Lord was taken up. Lk. 24:51 (Acts 1:9)

B. The apostles became the main focus during the early years of the church. vs.2b-3
1. The Lord showed Himself alive to them.
a. He showed Himself living to them after His passion.
b. He showed Himself living to them with many infallible proofs (tckqiov
a fixed mark, a sign, indubitable token, clear proof The Analytical Greek
Lexicon).
He was seen by them for forty days. vs.3
He was seen by 500 others. 1 Co. 15:6
He displayed his pierced hands and side. John 20:20,27
He served breakfast. John 21:12-15
He performed a miracle. John 21:6
2. The Lord gave them command to await the coming Holy Spirit in Jerusalem. vs.4
7
a. The promised relationship of the Holy Spirit they were to receive differed
from the relationship of the Holy Spirit under the baptism of John. vs. 5
* John baptized with water. Matt. 3:11; Acts 19:1-5; 13:24-25

* Believers from Pentecost forward would be baptized by the Holy
Spirit. vs.5
- Dr. Lukes use of the cv / oc construction draws a contrast
between Johns Baptism and the Baptism of the Holy Spirit.
-The Spirits baptism identifies the believer with Christs death,
burial and resurrection (2 Co. 12:13; Rom. 6:3-4).
-The Grace Believer does not repent to be baptized as was
necessary under Johns baptism (1 Peter 3:20).
- The believer believes the facts concerning the gospel and he is
saved (1Co. 15:3-4).
- Repentance is a result of this belief. (Acts 10: 44-47)
b. The disciples coming together kept on asking him (as an equal) concerning
the Kingdom from the Heavens. vs.6
-They use a first class condition to assert the belief that they think its
going to happen now. (Wilt should be translated since)
- The phrase restore again is the word otokotqiotovcio which
means to restore something to its former state. (ill. Lk. 6:10; Matt.
12:13)
c. Christ responded to the question of the disciples by instructing them on the
Fathers freedom from the constraint of men. vs.7
- The word for not used in the context is the Greek particle ouk
which is used to deny the reality of an alleged fact. It is the clear-cut
point-blank negative, objective, final. Dana & Mantey (ill. John
1:21)
- The word know is the word ivoeoko which is used in
Scripture of the difference between knowledge of facts versus
knowledge acquired by experience. (ill. Mk. 4:11; John 1:10; 14:7)
- Times and Seasons are used in scripture of certain periods scheduled
to occur in Gods plan and purposes. (1 Thess. 5:1)
ovoo is time, whether in respect of duration or a definite
point of its laps. An epoch, era, marked duration. Analytical
Greek Lexicon (ill Matt. 2:7; 25:19)
Koiouo is time measured by fitness, proportion, suitableness;
a fitting situation; a limited period of time marked by a
suitableness of circumstances. (ill. 1 Co. 4:5; Acts 17:30; Gal.
4:4)
- The word for put is the word ctqcto (aor. mid.) which means to
place, lay or set. Abbott & Smith (ill. Acts 13:47; 1Co. 12:18, 28; 1
Thess. 5:9)



8



d. In contrast to awaiting the coming of the Kingdom, the Lord redirects the
disciples focus to the beginning of a new dispensation. vs. 8
Luke uses an adversative conjunction oo (but) to emphasize
Gods change in His program. This should be translated:
but, on the contrary (to their knowledge of when the Kingdom
will be restored to Israel)
The reception of power was promised to the disciples.
- Power is an ability (ouvoiv in the Greek means
ability). (ill. Acts 3:12; 4:7,33; 6:8; 19:11)
- The power received by the disciples received was a by-
product of the Holy Spirit coming upon them which
was unique to the Dispensation of Grace. (ill. Acts
11:15-16)
Instead of the receiving the Kingdom from the Heavens, the
disciples were made witnesses for the new dispensation.
- Witness is the Greek word otuco from which we
get our English word martyr. The Greek Analytical
Lexicon defines the word to mean generally, a witness
to a circumstance. (ill. 7:58; Acts 10:39; 2:32; 3:15;
5:32)
- The disciples were witnesses firstly in Jerusalem. (ill.
Acts 2:14; 13:26-46)
- The disciples were witnesses secondly in Judea and
Sameria. (ill. Acts 8:4-8)
- The disciples were witnesses thirdly up to the edge of
the last of the earth (ill. Acts 9:26-38; ch.14-28)

C. Scene I of the Lord Jesus earthly ministry is completed at His ascension. vs.9
1. Three things occurred as the Lord finished speaking:
a. The disciples looked (|cto to glance).
b. The Lord was taken (aor. pass.) up
c. A cloud received Him from the sight of the disciples.
2. The events of the Lords ascension occurred so rapidly, the disciples were left
contemplating what had happened. vs.10a
a. The disciples were gazing (otcvi,ovtco -- to fix ones eyes upon, to look
steadily, gaze intently, to view with contemplation ill. Lk. 4:20) in the
heaven (first)
b. The phrase as He went up translates the Greek word tocuocvou which
means to go, pass on ones way, journey, travel. The word is accompanied
by a personal pronoun autou which makes the phrase emphatic His very
own journey
The phrase is used to emphasize the next phase in the Lords
participation in the Fathers plan and purposes.
9
The ascension of Christ was necessary for the believers present
tense salvation. John 16:5-13; 1 John 2:1-2
c. Two men stood by them as they gazed upon His ascension. vs.10b
The word for men is the Greek word ovoco which is defined
as a male person of full age and stature, as opposed to a child
or female. The Greek Analytical Lexicon (ill. Lk. 24:4)
The phrase white apparel is better understood having been
made to stand in a quality of white -- which appears to be the
common characteristic of angelic appearances in the Gospels.
(Ill. John 20:12)
d. The angels appeared to spur the disciples on after the shocking departure of
the one they expected to restore the Kingdom to Israel. vs.11a
The disciples were standing (perf. standing in the past with
the result that they were still standing), probably in shock.
The disciples were looking (Bcte to glancing as opposed to
gazing) into the heaven
e. The two men reveal truth about the second coming of Jesus to the disciples.
11b
He was taken (ovoqtqOcio a taking up, to receive up. ill.
Acts 20:13-14) into heaven (third).
He shall return (ccuoctoi -- to come or go.)
His return will be in the same manner (ov totov --) the
disciples watched Him go. (ill. Zech. 14:1-14)


D. The disciples followed Jesus instructions after His departure and returned to Jerusalem from
the Mount of Olives. vs.12
1. They entered into the upper room (an up stairs room. Traditionally the study and
the room for prayer of a rabbi. The use of the article designates this upper room as
one specific to the disciples)
2.They were recovered from the shock of the Lords departure.
a. They were carrying on in worship The Greek word is tookotcouvtco
Greek Analytical Lexicon to persist in adherence to a thing; to be intently
engaged in, attend constantly to.
Reinecker/Rogers -- to be strong, steadfast, like the English carry on).
b. They were of one mind in worship (ooOuooov -- to be with one mind,
with one accord, unanimously Analytical Greek Lexicon). Acts 2:1,46;
5:12
c. The disciples were together with Jesus mother and his brothers (probably
James and Jude who didnt believe before Christs crucifixion).






10



3. The Holy Spirit used the apostle Peter in the early stages of the Church. vs.15-26
a. The term in those days is used in Scripture to denote a particular time
frame that varies from days, to months to years. (ill. Matt. 3:1; Acts 2:18;
6:1; 7:41; Rev. 9:6)
b. Peter brought perspective from Scripture for all the things that had occurred
concerning the Lord Jesus.
1. Peter declared that the things that happened to the Lord were
necessary to the fulfillment of Scripture. (ill. Ps.69: 26; 109:8)
The Holy Spirit spoke before the things concerning Judas.
The Holy Spirit spoke through the mouth of David and
other prophets in the Old Testament. (ill. 2 Pet. 2:20-21)
2. Peter put Judas role in the betrayal of the Lord into Scriptural
context. vs.16
Judas came to be a guide (ooqou-- one who led the
way, normally for those who are blind ill. Matt. 23:24;
Rom. 2:19) to the ones arresting Jesus. Matt. 26:47-49
(They needed a guide for the opportune time Matt.
26:3-5; 21; 45-46)
Judas was a guide for those arresting Jesus
because he was numbered (kotoiOce-- to
enumerate, number with, count with) with the
disciples
Judas obtained (o_ove to have assigned to
one, to obtain, receive) the inheritance belonging
to the ministry. (ill. 2 Pet. 1:1; John 19:24)
Judas could not handle the magnitude of his behavior
(though he was unrepentant). vs.18 (ill. Matt. 27:3)
Judas (the money that he was paid to betray Jesus
was used for this purpose) brought a field with the
reward of unrighteousness. (Matt. 27:6)
Judas hang himself. (Matt. 27:5)
He fell flat on his face and burst asunder.
Judas betrayal left a tragic impression.
The word for habitation is the word defined in
the Greek language as a homestead, a country, a
house, cottage, cabin. Reinecker/Rogers
The word bishoprick is used to denote the
things that he was in charge of, to oversee. (ill
John 13:29)
3. Peter oversaw the process to replace Judas. vs.21
It was necessary (oci -- something that had to happen,
that which is not optional) that Judas replacement came
from among those who were ouvcOovtev coming
11
intimately together with the disciples during the time of
Jesus earthly ministry: vs.22a
From the time the Lord Jesus entered among the
disciples
To the time the Lord Jesus left the disciples.
From the baptism of John to the point that Jesus
was taken up from the disciples.
The one selected would become a witness together with
the disciples of the Lords resurrection. vs.22b
Two men met the qualifications: vs.23
Justus (Col. 4:11??)
Matthias
Two things brought the disciples to a conclusion
concerning who would replace Judas. vs.25
Worship
Casting lots (kqouothe method employed by
the J ews was to put the names written on stones
into a vessel and shake it until one fell out ill.
Matt. 27:35 -- Reinecker/Rogers)
Matthias was numbered (oukotcq|i,e to be chosen
by vote; then to be added Reinecker/Rogers) vs.26

























12


CHAPTER 2



II. THE COMING OF THE HOLY SPIRITS SIGNIFIED A CHANGE OF DISPENSATIONS.
A. The Day of Pentecost was a traditional celebration by the Nation Israel. vs. 1 (ill. Lev.
23:11-16; Acts 20:16; 1 Co. 16:8)
Note: The name Pentecost is derived from the Greek Pentekostos meaning fiftieth, which was applied to
the fiftieth day after the Passover. It was the culmination of the Feast of Weeks (Ex. 34:22; Deut.
16:10) which began on the third day after the Passover with the presentation of the first harvest sheaves
to God and which concluded with the offering of tow loaves of un-leaven bread, representing the first
products of the harvest. After the exile, it became one of the great pilgrimage feasts of Judaism, at which
many of those who lived in remote sections of the Roman world returned to Jerusalem for worship. (Acts
10:16). For that reason it served as a bond to unite the Jewish world of the first century and to remind
them of their history Evangelical Dictionary of Theology

B. The setting of the Holy Spirits coming was at the completion of the day. vs. 1
1. The phrase fully come (outouoOoi) denotes to fill completely of time, to
approach, to come Reinecker/Rogers
2. The significance of the Holy Spirits coming at Pentecost is the difference between
the theological term residency, indwelling, and omnipresence.

C. The word they refers back to those in Chapter 1:13-14. (approximately 120)

D. An echo occurred while they together. vs.1-2
1. The word echo is the Greek word denoting a reverberating sound or noise or roar.
(ill. Lk. 21:25; 1 Co. 13:1; Lk. 4:37)
2. The echo occurred suddenly.
3. The echo came out (ck) from the third heaven.
4. The echo was as being borne of a violent wind.
a. The word as is eotc as it were. (ill. 1 Co. 15:8)
b. The word of is better translated by the word |cocvqo -- to carry, to be
driven. (ill 2 Pet. 1:21; Acts 27:15)
c. The words rushing mighty can better be translated violent; a blowing blast.
(ill Acts 17:25)
5. The echo filled the whole house where they were sitting.

E. Tongues like fire appeared to each of them. vs.3
1. The phrase cloven tongues as of fire:
a. The word tongue is the word ooooi which is used in Scripture to denote
the physical tongue, tribes and languages.
Physical use Ja. 3:6; Rom. 3:13; Mk. 7:33
Tribes Rev. 5:9; 7:9; 13:7
Languages Acts 2; 11; 10:46; 1 Co. 14:22
b. The tongues were distributed (Aioci,ocvoi to distribute, parting
13
themselves asunder or distributing themselves Reinecker/Rogers) upon
each of them. (ill. Acts 2:45)
c. The tongues were like (eoci) fire.
2. The tongues appeared to each of them.
3. The tongues sat upon each (.sace, each individual one)

F. The event culminated in all those being present being filled by the Holy Spirit. vs.4a
1. The word for filling of the Holy Spirit is different from that used later in Scripture.
a. Hitqi is the word used at Pentecost and it means that which fills or takes
possession of the mind. (ill Lk. 1:15, 41, 67; 4:28; Acts 3:10;4:8,31)
b. Hqoe is the word used of the Holy Spirits filling in later years of the
church. ill. Eph. 5:18; Rom. 15:13)
2. The filling of the Holy Spirit upon all was unique to the Dispensation of Grace.

G. Speaking in other tongues resulted from the Holy Spirits filling. vs.4b
1. The term other is the word heteros (heterosexual) tongues of a different kind than
theirs. (ill. Jude 7; Rom. 7; 3; Gal. 1:6; Eph. 3:5)
2. They spoke as the Holy Spirit gave them utterance (oto|Ocooi). (ill Acts
2:14; 26:25)
a. Reinecker/Rogers to utter to speak, use of weighty or aracular utterance.
b. Abbott & Smith to speak forth, give utterance.
3. The message they spoke was concerning the mighty deeds of God. vs. 11

H. The events of the Holy Spirits coming caused a great commotion among the Godly Jews in
Judea. vs.5
1. The word for devout signifies caution and carefulness in respect of divine things. (ill
Lk. 2:25; Acts 8:2)
2. The devout Jews were (out from as to source) all nations under (the) heaven (as a
result of the scattering of the nation after the Babylonian captivity)
3. The sound (vs.2) brought the multitude of devout Jews together. vs.6a
a. They all came together (ouvqOc passive) when they heard the sound.
b. They were confounded (ouvc_uOq aor. passive to be perplexed. It
describes the surprising effect of the miracle). over the sound.

I. The source of the devout Jews perplexity was what they heard subsequent to the Holy
Spirits coming. vs.6b

1. Each (.sace,) one (the devout Jews) heard them (the disciples and others in the
upper room) speaking in their (the devout Jews) very own (idia) dialect
(Aiockte). (ill. Acts 1:19; 21:40; 26:14)
a. Joseph Thayer the tongue or language peculiar to any people.
b. Analytical Greek Lexicon speech; manner of speaking; peculiar language
of a nation, vernacular, idiom.
2. The devout Jews were amazed and marveled at the miracle. vs.7
a. They knew that all those speaking in tongues were Galileans.
b. But, they were able to hear each of those Galileans in our (qev) own
14
(idios) dialect in which we were born:
Parthians
Medes
Elamites
Dwellers in:
* Mesopotamia
* Judea
* Cappadocia
* Pontus
* Asia
* Phrygia
*Pamphylia Egypt
*In the regions of Libya
*Cyrene
* Temporarily residing Roman Jews and proselytes
*Cretes
* And Arabians
3. Though all were amazed at the miracle that occurred, a splintering of opinions arose.
vs.12-13
a. Some (of the same kind) were troubled over what occurred.
b. Some (of the same kind) were asking ti Occi touto civoi?
c. Others (of a different kind) mocked saying they are:
Filled ccotecvoi
With sweet wine cukouo

J. The apostle Peter answers the charges made by those devout Jews. vs. 14-37
1.Peter took the leadership in setting the record straight concerning the events that
occurred.
a. Peter rose to answer the charges. vs. 14a
b. Peter stood together with the eleven other disciples. vs. 14b
c. Peter addressed those to whom his message was directed. vs.14c
Men of Judea
All ye that dwell at Jerusalem
d. Peter ask two things of his audience before he begins:
Let this thing be made known unto you
Hearken to my words
e. Peter refutes the notion that those filled with the Spirit were drunk. vs.15
The belief that they were drunk was something that they had
imagined.
Proof they werent drunk was that it was the third hour of the
day.

2. Contrarily the apostle links the events of the day to the prophecies made concerning
the coming of the Holy Spirit in the last days. vs.16-37
a. Peter uses a neuter pronoun to explain that the pouring out of the Holy Spirit
was prophesied to occur through the prophet Joel. vs.16 (12,14); Joel 3:1-5
15
i. God would pour from His Spirit:
In the last days
Upon all flesh
ii. The result of the pouring out of the Spirit:
3. Peter explains the significance of Jesus to the Jews.
a. He was from Nazareth.
b. He was a man accredited to you (Jews) by God.
i. He was accredited through the mighty deeds that He
performed.
ii. He was accredited through the wonders He did.
iii. He was accredited through the signs He performed.
c. He was betrayed in accordance with Gods decree.
d. He was rejected by His own people.
i. You (Jews) killed Him.
ii. God raised Him out from the dead because it was impossible
for death to hold Him. vs.24
e. David prophesied the Lords resurrection. vs.25-27 (Ps. 15:8-11)
i. David forsaw the Lord before me always. vs.24
Because he was at my right hand
For the purpose that I not be moved
ii. Davids foresight brought joy. vs.25-26
Therefore is better rendered because of this thing.
My heart was Glad
My tongue exalted
My flesh dwells upon hope.
iii. Resurrection from the grave was the source of the joy. vs.27-28
Because you did not abandon my soul into hades.
Nor will Thou give the Holy one to see corruption.
Thou has made known to me the ways of life.
Thou shalt make me full of joy with thy countenance.
iv. Peter spoke with boldness concerning the patriarch David,
that the prophecy could not have been in reference to himself.
vs.29-31
Because David both died and was buried and is in his
tomb. vs.29
David was aware of the oath God swore to him. vs.30
One out from then fruit of his loins would sit upon
his throne. Ps. 132:11; 89:4
Foreseeing that one out from the fruit of his loins
would sit upon his throne, he spoke concerning
the resurrection of the Christ. vs.31-32
-He was not abandoned into hades.
-Neither did His flesh see corruption.
-This same Jesus, God raised which we are all
witnesses.
16
Christ sent the promised Holy Spirit being exhalted to the
right hand of the Father. vs.33
The Son received the promised Holy Spirit
The Son poured out the promised Holy Spirit this
thing, which you have seen and heard.
Peter asserts his interpretation to be the only Scriptural
answer to the events that had occurred:
For, David didnt ascend into the heaven.
But, the Lord (the Father) said to my Lord (Son)
sit out from my right hand until I make thine
enemies thy footstool.
Peter concluded with a proclamation to the house of
Israel. vs.36
Assuredly therefore
Let the house of Israel know
God the Father has made the same Jesus (which
you crucified) both Lord and Christ.
f. Some devout Jews responded to Peters message. vs.37
i. Hearing
ii. They were cut to the heart
iii. They said to both Peter and the rest of the apostles
iv. What must they do?
g. Peters prescription for the devout Jews was three-fold. vs.38
i. Repent
ii. Be baptized upon the name of Jesus Christ because of
forgiveness of sins.
iii. Receive the gift of the Holy Spirit.
h. Peter defines those to whom his promise was applicable. vs.39
i. The promise is to your children
ii. The promise is to those far away
iii. The promise is to as many as the Lord our God shall call.
i. Peter exhorted the devout Jews with many words of a different kind. vs.40
i. He exhorted they by saying:
ii. Save yourself from this perverse generation (Israel?).
j. The response of the Jews to Peters message led to their salvation. vs.41-43a
i. They gladly received his word.
ii. They were baptized.
iii. There were added three thousand souls in that day.
iv. They continued steadfastly in the apostles doctrine
v. They continued steadfastly in fellowship
vi. They continued steadfastly in the breaking of bread.
vii. They continued steadfastly in prayers (worship)
viii. Fear came upon every soul.
h. There were other events that occurred. vs.43-44
i. Many wonders and signs were done by the apostles.
ii. All that believed were together and shared all things in common.
17
iii. All that believed sold their possessions and goods and parted
them to every man who had need.
iv. They continued daily with one accord.
v. They broke bread from house to house.
vi. They ate their meat with gladness and singleness of heart.
vii. They were praising God.
viii. They were having favor with all people. vs.47
ix. The Lord added to the Church daily such as should be saved.






































18



Chapter 3



I. THE MESSAGE OF THE APOSTLES CONCERNING JESUS CHRIST IS AUTHENTICATED
THROUGH THE HEALING OF THE LAME MAN.
A. God used Peter and John to heal a man crippled from birth. Acts 3:1-8
1. Peter and John encountered the impotent man on their way to the temple. vs.1
a. The word translated went up is ovc|oivov, a descriptive imperfect which
means to ascend the terraces.
b. The ninth hour of prayer was 3:00 p.m in the afternoon.
2. The lame man had been lame from his mothers womb. vs.2-3
a. The term lame is the word _qov which means maimed. (ill. Acts 14:8)
i. DNTT the reference is either implicitly or explicitly to
impairment of the legs and feet.
ii. Reinecker/Rogers the word is used in classical writing to describe
a lame condition in the legs or feet which produced a halting or
limping gait (a manner of walking or moving on foot)
b. He laid daily (c|ooto,cto) denotes that he was carried to the temple gate
simultaneous to the going up o the apostles.
c. The purpose of his placement at the gate was to ask alms, from the ones
entering (covtoo denotes being about to enter) into the temple. vs.2
d. Peter and John fastening (otcvi,e) their eyes upon going into the temple.
vs.4
i. Abbott & Smith to look fixly gazed (this word is used numerous
times in Acts with connection with performance of miracles. Ill. Acts
10:4; 13:9; 14:9
ii. Context of Scripture denote and intense looking with the purpose
of discerning a matter.
3. The lame man gave heed to Peters address to him indicating that he had faith. vs.3-5
(vs.16)
a. The term gave heed is the Greek word translated ctic_e.
i. Reinecker/Rogers to aim at, to fix ones attention upon.
ii. Abbott & Smith to observe, to give attention to.
b. He attention was focused on receiving something. vs.5
4. Peter did two things in healing the lame man.
a. Peter had no (possessions to give the lame man). vs.6
b. On the contrary, Peter said: c_e touto oioei ooi I have this thing I give
you.

5. Peter made two crucial statements in healing the lame man:
a. Ev te o=ooti Iqoou Xiotou o| No,eoiou (In the name of Jesus
Christ of Nazareth)
19
i. The phrase in the name of Jesus is used often in Acts. It is the bases
of the things the Apostles accomplished (Acts 2:38; 5:28; 8:12)
ii. The fact that Jesus was from Nazareth is a reason many rejected Him,
consequently, Peter continued to emphasize it.
* Jesus was raised in Nazareth. Lk. 4:16
* Nazareth was looked down on as a place of nobodies. John
1:45-46.
b. Ecic koi tcitotci (rise and walk around) vs.6
6. Peter took him (seized him, took hold of him) by the right hand vs.7-8
a. His feet and ankle bones immediately received strength (cotcceOqoov --
to make form or solid Heb. 5:12,14)
b. He began leaping.coocvoo to leap out, to leap up.
c. He walking and entered with (Peter and John) into the temple.
d. He continued leaping and praising (Heb. 13:15) God.


B. The healing of the lame man caused amazement among those who witnessed the healed
man walking. Acts 3:9-11
1. The People a phrase used to denote those in the nation Israel.
2. They saw him walking.
3. They saw him praising God.
4. They knew ctciveokov (they began to perceive, recognize) that it was the
impotent man.
5. Those who saw him healed were filled (titqi) with wonder and
amazement. (ekstasews an abnormal condition of the mind in which the subject
passes out of his usual self-control). Mk. 5:42; Lk. 5:26
6. The impotent man held himself to Peter and John.
7. The crowd ran ouvcoocv -- to make a run. in greatly wondering OoBouo to be
amazed, astonished, terrified. (Mk.1: 27; 10:32)



II. THE APOSTLES MESSAGE ABOUT JESUS CHRIST RESULTS IN A FINAL OFFER OF
THE KINGDOM TO THE NATION ISRAEL.
A. Peter connects the healing of the lame man to Gods message to the Nation Israel. Acts
3:12-26
1. Peter answered (otckivoto ---to answer, to separate, divide from Cremer) the
crowd as they came together.
2. The context of the audience is established with the phrase Ye men of Israel. vs.12a
3. Peter divests he and John of the ability to heal the impotent man. vs.12b
a. Peter was perplexed at the crowds marveling of the mans healing.
b. The word look is otcvi,ctc which means to look with a fixed gaze. Acts
1:10; 10:4

4. Peter attributes the lame mans healing to Man with whom the Jews rejected.
a. Peter ties Jesus authenticity to the God of the Jewish fathers.
20
i. God the Father glorified (coooocv ill. John 7:39; 11:4; 12:16;
17:1,4,5; 21:19) His son.
ii. The word for Son is the Greek word Hoioo is a term used of Christ
that references Old Testament prophecy about Him to which the Jews
would have been familiar. (ill. Is.42: 1-5)

5. Peter informs the Jews of Gods inditement against them for their role in the death of
their Messiah
a. They delivered (tocookotc --to release, to betray John 18:29-31,35-36;
Lk. 24:20) Him up in the presence of Pilate.
b. They denied (ovcooi to deny takes place upon the ground of, and
with the underlying better conviction to the contrary in other words they
were unconvinced that He was Messiah) Him
i. They denied Him before Pilate. (John 19:14-15:19-22)
ii. Pilate had judged to release Him. John 19:12; Lk. 23:14;Matt. 27:18
c. They desired that a murderer be granted to them. Matt. 27:15-21
d. They killed the Prince of the life.
i. The word Prince is o_qov which is defined originator, founder,
leader, chief, first. Heb. 5:9; 12:2
ii. The Life is used in Scripture to denote that eternal quality of life that
the believer has as a result of regeneration. (ill. Eph. 4:18; Rom. 8:2)
e. God raised Him (ck vckev out from among dead ones, meaning there
were still others dead in the grave) from the dead. (ill. Rom. 4:24)

6. Peter connects the healing of the lame man with the nations rejection of Christ.
a. The lame man was made strong through the faith concerning Christs
name (ovootoo denotes the character of one -- ill. Acts
4:30; 5:41; 8:12; 9:16; 10:43; 15:26).
b. Faith provided by Christ led to the lame mans healing.
i. Faith to believe was given (coekcv) to the lame man (ill. 1 Co. 3:5)
ii. He was made whole (ookqiov denotes soundness in all parts
body, soul and spirit Reincecker/Rogers 1 Thess. 5:23; Jas. 1:4)
before all the Jews because of his faith.

B. Peter advances the reason as to why the Jews killed their Messiah.
1. The Jews killed Christ because of ignorance (ovoce to not recognize, not to know,
to be unacquainted with). vs.17 (ill. Acts 13:27-30; Rom. 10:3)
2. The word did is ctootc which is from the word meaning to practice. (ill.
1Thess. 4:11; Phil. 4:9)

C. Peter links the Jews killing of Messiah to fulfillment of O.T. Scripture. vs.18
1. The term beforehand is tokoooce which is to report beforehand, too
announce fully before hand.
2. The term suffer is toOciv (ill Ps. 22; Is. 53:7-10).
3. Christ is better translated the Christ, the Messiah which was expected. (ill. Matt.
16:13-20; John 4:25; 7:41)
21

D. Peter makes a final offer to Israel of establishment of the Kingdom.
vs.19
1. The word therefore is used in light of the evidence Peter has presented concerning
the nation and their rejection of Messiah.
2. The Jews are called upon to repent (ctovoqootc - to have a change of mind) ill.
Acts 5:31
3. The result of the Jews repentance would be conversion, ctiotctqe, to turn (ill.
Acts 11:21)
4. The result of the Jews conversion is their sins would be blotted out coci|e to
washover; to wipe out; to obliterate; to cancel a debt) ill. Col. 2:14
5. Times of refreshing would be a direct result of their repentance. vs.19
a. The word times is koioo which means a season. It is used in Scripture to
denote a fitting occasion. (ill. Acts 24:26; 2 Thess. 2:6)
b. Refreshing is the word ovo|uceo to cool again, refresh. (ill. 2 Tim.
1:16) 2 Pet. 3:12
6. God would send Jesus Christ as a result of their repentance. vs.21
a. The phrase before was preached unto you in Greek means to be previously
appointed for you. (ill. Acts 10:41; 22:14)
b. Heaven received Him until the time of restitution.
i. The word times is _ovev which measure chronological time, the
logical sequence of events.
ii. The word restitution is otokotootooceo restoration, the
establishment of all that has been promised in the Old Testament.
(ill. Lk. 6:10; Mk 9:12; Acts 1:6)
iii. All things spoken of by the prophets includes prophecy concerning
Israel. (ill. Lk. 1:70-79)

D. Adherence to Christ was prophesized.
1. Moses warned of judgment for all who rejected the message of that prophet. vs.
22-23 (Deut. 18:5-20)
2. It was prophesied by Samuel and all the other prophets that followed Him. vs. 24

E. Gods message was first sent to the Nation Israel. vs. 26
1. They are the Sons of the prophets.
2. They are the sons of the covenants which God made with the Fathers. (Gen. 12:3;
18:18; 22:18; 26:4)
3. God sent His servant, Christ to turn each of them from their evil (tovqoo)








22



Chapter 4



I. THE JEWISH LEADERS RESORTED TO PERSECUTION OF THE APOSTLES IN AN
ATTEMPT TO STIFLE THE MESSAGE OF THEIR REJECTION OF THEIR MESSIAH.
vs. 1-12
A. The Jewish leaders reacted to Peter and Johns proclamation of the Jews role in the
rejection of the Messiah. vs.1-3
1. The Priests, the captain of the temple and the Sadducees came upon them. vs.1
2. The Priests, the captain of the temple and the Sadducees were grieved
(Aiotovoucvoi to be worked up, to be indignant Acts 16:18) over their
teaching. vs.2
3. The apostles were imprisoned (tqqoio --- a place of custody, probably in a
chamber of the templeRienecker/Rogers) as a results of their teaching. vs.3

B. Five thousand believed the message of the apostles in spite of the rejection of the Jewish
leaders. vs.4

C. The Jewish leaders brought Peter and John before them to inquire of their preaching.
1. There was a list of Jewish leaders in attendance eager to make the apostles account
for their teaching. vs.6 (all definitions from Westminister Dictionary of the Bible)
a. The rulers an officer in the synagogue (Matt. 9:18; Mk. 5:22-38; Lk.
8:41)
b. The elders those who administered the nations civil and religious affairs-
(Matt. 15:2; 21:23; 26:3,47)
c. The scribes Those who devoted themselves to the study and interpretation
of the law, which was both civil and religious; and to determine its
applictation to the details of daily life. The decisions of the great scribes
became the oral law or tradition. Matt. 16:21; 26:3; 8:19; 21:15
d. Annas the high priest He was the supreme pontiff and representive of the
Nation before Yahweh. (ill. Heb. 5:1-2)
e. Caiaphas He served as high priest along with his father in-law Annas. It
was he who proposed the death of J esus in order to preserve the rest of the
nation. (John 11:49-53; 18:14,24)
f. As many as were of the kindred of the high priest included John and
Alexander.
2. The Jews asked (ctuvOovovto to inquire, demand, seek information that would
answer unsolved issues. Context Matt. 2:4; Acts 21:33) as to the source of their
power (ouvoio) in healing the lame man. vs.7
3. Peter answers the query of the Jewish leaders.vs.10-
a. He addresses those present (Ye rulers of the people, and elders of Israel)
vs.8
23
b. He addresses the occasion. vs.9
i. The apostles were being examined (ovokive, denotes a questioning
for the purpose of drawing a conclusion Context Acts 12:19; 28:18)
ii. Their examination was on the basis of a good deed (ill. Acts 10:38)
c. He addresses the source of their powerJesus Christ of Nazareth. vs.10
i. The Jews crucified Him.
ii. God raised Him from the dead.
iii. He was the stone which was set at nought of you builders vs.11
(Ps.118)
iv. Salvation under any other name is not possible. vs.12
* Dr. Luke uses ou, the most emphatic negative in the Greek
language to emphasize the absence of salvation in any other
(oe -- of the same kind)
* There is no name (qctcoo name of a different kind) given
- under (uto) the heaven (third heaven)
- among mankind
- by which it is necessary (oci) for salvation.

4. The Jewish leaders beheld the boldness of the apostles response to their inquiry.
vs.13a
a. The word beheld is the Greek word Ocece which means to look at, to
gaze. (ill. Acts 25:24)
b. Boldness (toqoiov) denotes the confidence and forthrightness with
which the apostles spoke under the prompting of the Holy Spirit.
Reinecker/Rogers (ill. 2 Co. 7:4; Eph.3:12)
5. The Jewish leaders perceived (kotoo|ocvoi to grasp with the mind
Reinecker Rogers John 1:5; Acts 10:34) certain characteristics about the apostles.
vs.13b
a. They perceived that they were unlearned and ignorant men.
i. The word unlearned is oootoo denoting uneducated, unable to
write. Here it denotes the lack of rabbinic training. Reinecker/Rogers
ii. The word ignorant is ioiotoi, one who is not an expert, unskilled,
commoner. (ill. 2 Co. 11:6)
b. They marveled (inceptive imperfect) they began to wonder over their
background.
c. They recognized (gained experiential knowledge) they had been together
with Jesus.
6. The presence of the healed man together with Peter and John made refutation of the
miracle impossible. vs.14

D. The circumstances behind the miracle and teaching left the Jewish leaders perplexed as to
their next step. vs.15
1. They command the apostles and the healed man to go outside the council (a local
J ewish tribunal; the ecclesiastical court of the J ews Abbott & Smith Matt.
10:17; Mk. 13:9).
2. They conferred with one another as to what action should be taken.
24
i. A notable (one that is a matter of knowledge Abbott & Smith Acts 1:19)
sign miracle had been performed: vs.16
* It was done by (the instrumentality of) the apostles
* It was know before all dwelling in Jerusalem.
* It was undeniable ouvoctqo ovcioOoi did not have the ability
to say no to it.
ii. Damage control was the issue before the Jewish leaders. vs.17
They threatened them to no longer speak upon Jesus name in order
that news of the miracle spread no further among the Jews.
* They threatened them to no longer teach in the name of Jesus. vs.18



II. PETER AND JOHN AND OTHER BELIEVERS ARE UNDAUNTED BY THE
THREATENINGS OF THE JEWISH LEADERS. vs.19-31
A. The apostles reject the threatenings of the Jewish leaders. vs.19
1. The apostles left the question whether they should listen to God or men to the Jewish
leaders judgment. vs.19
2. The apostles emphasized the impossibility of their refusing to speak concerning the
things they have seen and heard. vs.20

B. The Jewish leaders issued further threats and released the apostles. vs.21
1. They further threatened the disciples.
2. They released them.
*They released them due to the fact they found no means of punishing them.
* They released them because all men glorified God cti te covoti (for the
thing having happened.)
*The sign miracle occurred to a man more than forty years old. vs.22


C. Peter and John were unshaken by their persecution upon their release. vs.22-23
1. They went to their own company (a Greek idiom that is used in Scripture to denote
those in a certain group or relationship, in this instance other believers. John 13:1;
Matt. 25:14).
2. The reported all (ooo whatsoever things) that the chief priest and elders had said
to them

D. The believers were unified in their reaction to the rejection of the chief priest and the elders.
vs.24
1. They all with one accord (ooOuooov emphasizes a unity of mind ill. Acts
5:12; 19:29; Rom. 15; 6) lifted up their voice to God.
2. They begin in worship. Acts 4:24b
a. Lord is the word ocototo a sovereign the word is used to by the
believers to show their servant role. (ill 2 Tim. 2:20)
b. They acknowledge that it was He who made the heaven and the earth and the
sea and all things that are in them. (ill. Acts 17:23-28)
25
3. The quote of Psalms 2 point towards the fact the religious leaders fulfilled Scripture
in their rejection of the Messiah. vs.25-26
a. The heathen raged (c|uocv - to snort, to be arrogant, haughty, insolent)
ill. Matt. 27:27-37; John 18:33-38; 19:9-11

b. The people devised (cctoe to devise, to plan Reinecker/Rogers) vain
things. ill. Mark. 13:11 (Matt. 21:43-46; Lk. 4:28-29; John 7:30)
c. The kings of the earth (Lk. 23:7-12) and the rulers (1 Co. 2:7-8) assembled
together against the Lord and His Messiah.
5. The communication to the Father reveals those complicit in Christs death. vs.27
a. Herod
b. Pontius Pilate
c. The Gentiles
d. The people of Israel
6. These all conspired to kill Christ. vs.28
a. To do whatsoever the hand (is used in Scripture to denote power or authority.
Ill. Acts 7:25; 13:11; Heb. 10:31) foreordained (tooi,o to mark out
the bounds before; predetermined) to happen.
b. To do whatsoever the counsel (decree Eph. 1:11) foreordained to happen.
7. The apostles appeal to the Father to help them in their persecution. vs.29
a. They ask concerning relief from the Jews
i. Now Lord --
ii. Look upon the threatenings of them.
b. They asked for help in their ministry. 29-30
i. Grant unto thy servants that with all boldness (toooio
confidence 2 Co. 3:12; Eph. 3:12; 1 John 2:28) they may speak thy
Word
ii. Stretch forth thy hand.
* The result of stretch forth His hand would be healing.
* The result of stretching forth His hand would be signs and
wonders done in the name of thy holy child Jesus.
8. The apostles communication was immediately answered. vs.31
a. And when they had prayed --
b. The place was shaken where they were assembled together.
c. They were all filled (mentally) with the Holy Spirit.
d. They spake the Word of God with boldness.`


III. COMMONALITY REMAINED SUPREME AMONG BELIEVERS AT THAT TIME. vs. 32-
37
A. The multitude was united. vs. 32
1. They were of one heart.
2. They were of one soul.

B. They shared their possessions. vs.32
1. They didnt consider the things they possessed to be their own.
26
2. All things were to them common.

C. The Holy Spirit was evident in the ministry of the Apostles. vs.33
1. Great power was given to them in their testimony.
2. Great grace was upon them all.
D. No one among them lacked anything. vs.34-35
1. There was no one needy among them.
2. Those possessors of lands and houses sold them and brought the prices of the things
that was being sold.
3. They laid the things brought and placed them at the apostles feet.
4. The possessions were distributed to every man according as he had need.
5. Barnabas typified those believers who sold their possessions.
a. Scripture gives information about his background. vs.36
* His name defined his personality.
* He was a Levite (from the priestly line).
* He was of the country of Cyprus
b. Barnabas sold land and brought the money and laid it at the apostles feet.
vs.37




























27



Chapter 5




I. THE HOLY SPIRITS PRESENCE RAISED THE LEVEL OF ACCOUNTABILITY FOR
BELIEVERS IN THE DISPENSATION OF GRACE. Acts 5:1-11
A. Judgment is brought upon Ananias and his wife Sapphira for lying.
1. The couple sold (the word sold is tece which means to barter, it is contrasted with
ooo,ovtco which means to purchase with cash -- ill. Lk. 17:28; Rev. 13:17)
property to provide for the common good of the church as others had done. vs.1 (ill.
Acts 4:34-35)
2. The couple failed to give all of the proceeds of the transaction that they promised to
God. vs.2
a. They kept back (cvoo|iooto) part of the price.
* Marvin Vincent to embezzle, to secretly take a part of a larger
quantity which had been given to one as a trust ill. Tit.2:10
* Joseph Thayer to set apart or separate for ones self, i.e. to purloin,
embezzle, withdraw covertly and appropriate to ones own use.
b. Sapphira was privy -ouvoioo conscious, aware, complicit) to what was
done.
c. They took a certain part (coo a portion) and laid it at the apostles
feet.
3. Peter confronts the couple concerning the lie.
a. Peter traces the source of the lie to Satan. vs.3
* Satan filled (ctqoocv filled up what is lacking) his heart.
* The purpose for the filling of his heart was to lie (feusasQai to
deceive, cheat, show ones self deceitful Thayer) to the Holy Spirit.

(Ananas lie was considered a lie to the Holy Spirit because it was
the Holy Spirit who was leading him to make the offeringa role
not filled by the Holy Spirit under law)

b. Peter emphasizes the uselessness of the lie. vs.4
*The property was in Ananias authority (couoio -- delegated
powerLk. 4:6) before it was sold.
*The property was at Ananias disposal (utq_c in ones power or
disposal Thayer).
c. Ananias conceived the thing in his heart that Satan filled his heart with.
* The word conceived is from the Greek word titqi (Mid. Voice)

i. Marvin Vincent -- which means to put or fix, resolve upon it.
ii. Joseph Thayer to propose to ones self, to purpose; to place
28
or position for the execution of ones purpose. (ill. Acts 19:21;
2 Co. 5:19; Lk. 9:44

* The word thing is too that which has been done; a deed, an
accomplished fact. (ill. 2 Co. 7:11)
4. The wages for Anasias sin was death. vs.5-6
a. He started falling while hearing Peters words.
b. He gave up the ghost is the Greek word (cc|uc -- a term used by
medical writers; to breath out, to expire Reinecker/Rogers) while falling.
c. Fear dominated those who heard of the event.
d. Young men wrapped Ananias, carried him out for burial.
5. Sapphira came before Peter unaware (oioo not knowing the facts) of what had
happened to her husband. vs.7-10
a. She came in a three hour interval (space of time) after her husband expired.
vs.7
b. Peter quizzed her concerning the amount for which the land was sold. vs.8
*Peter asked why she had agreed together (ouvc|evqOq to agree
together passive denotes be made to agree) to tempt the Holy
Spirit. vs.9a
*Peter warned of her impending death.vs.9b
*Sapphira died. vs. 10
- She fell down straightway (tooqo immediate,
forthwith, instantly Reinecker/Rogers) at his feet.
- She yielded up the ghost (expired).
- The young men came in and found her dead.
6. The judgment of Ananias and Sapphira had an effect on the early church.
a. Great fear came upon all the church (this is the first mention of the term
church in Acts. The Greek word is Ekkcoio called out assembly).
vs.11a
b. Great fear came upon as many as heard these things. vs.11b



II. THE HANDS OF THE APOSTLES PRODUCED SIGNS AND WONDERS. Acts. 5:12-16
A. The hands of the apostles produced miracles that validated their apostleship. vs.12a
1. Signs were done among the people (Israel). The word signs indicates that the
event is not an empty ostentation of power, but it is significant in that it points
beyond itself to the reality of the might hand of God in operation Reineker/Roger
(John 2:11; Acts 4:16; 15:12)
2. Wonders were done among the people (Israel) The word wonders denotes terrible
appearances which elicit fright and horror, and which contradict the ordered unity
of nature DNTT (Acts 2:19; 7:36; 14:3)

B. All the believers were of one mind. vs.12b
1. One mind is a compound word
a. Homo the same
29
b. Thumos burning, heart
2. The term one mind denotes a unity.
a. DNTT the visible, inner unity of a group faced by a common duty or
danger. The unanimity is not based on common personal feelings but on a
cause greater than the individual.
b. Liddell & Scott one mind, unanimous.
3. It is used in Acts of believers united in purpose in the midst of persecution and the
enemies of Christianity united in purpose against believers.
a. It is used believers united in purpose in the midst of persecution.

C. The place of meeting at that time was Solomons porch (a splendid colonnade, according
to tradition built by Solomon, on the east side of the Temple area, on an artificial
embankment built upon the Valley of the Kidron). vs.12c

D. The activities of the early Church had a profound effect on those who witnessed the church
in action.vs.13-14
1. No one dared to be joined (koooOoi the word implies a forced, unnatural, or
unexpected union; the sense of an unnatural union Marvin Vincent 1Co. 6:16,
17) to them. vs.13a
2. The people (Jews) magnified (ccouvc to make large, to magnify
Reinecker/Rogers Phil. 1:21) them. 13b
3. More were added (tooctiOcvto to add to, emphasizes repeated actions
Reinecker/Rogers) to the Lord. vs.14 (both men and women)

E. The numbers of those believing grew to such an extent that many were brought to be healed
by Peter. vs.15-16
1. Sick were brought in great numbers in hopes his shadow would overshadow some.
vs.15
2. Multitudes from surrounding cities of Jerusalem brought sick who were healed. vs.16


III. THE HANDS OF THE APOSTLES BROUGHT PERSECUTION FROM THE JEWISH
LEADERS. Acts 5:17-42
A. The High priest and the Sadducees took offense to the works of the apostles.
1. They were filled (titqi complete mental filling in passive voice used to
denote the miracles caused them to be filled) with indignation. vs.17
2. They laid their hands on the apostles and put them in a common prison. vs.18
a. Common is the Greek word Aqooio which means public.
b. Prison is tqqoci which means to keep.
c. Used together it should be translated a place of public keeping.

3. The angel of the Lord (the word angel is anarthorous and should be
translated an angel of the Lord) rescued the apostles. vs.19
a. He appeared at night time.
b. He opened
c. He led them out.
30
d. He instructed the apostles to speak in the temple:
* To the people -- Israel
* All the words of this life.
i. The word life is the word ,eq which is eternal life, the higher
form of life; the life of God indwelling in the believer because
Christ indwells the believer. 2 Co. 4:10-11; 1 John 5:11-12;
Acts 13:46, 48; Acts 11:18)
ii. The term words is the word qcoto which are utterances;
individual parts versus the whole. (ill. Eph. 6:17)

B. The apostles respond to the angels instructions entering into the temple in the early
morning and taught. vs.21

C. The Jewish leaders were surprised to find they were not in their prison cell.
1. They gathered (toocvocvoi to come on the scene, to appear) to meet to
consider their fate. vs.22
2. The officers found the prison cell empty. vs.22-23
a. The officers reported that the prison was found shut (kckciocvov to
close, shut the per. pass. Part. Denotes it hadnt been opened from the
time that it was shut with them in it with the abiding result that it was still
in a state of being shut)
b. The officers reported that the keepers were standing (cotetoo standing
when the doors were closed with the abiding result that they are still
standing) without before the doors
c. The officers found no man within.
3. There existed perplexity over the direction of the situation. vs.24
a. The Jewish leaders were perplexed (Aiqtoouv to be thoroughly at a loss
the imperfect denotes they were in a state of being at a loss).
b. There perplexity involved whereunto this would grow (ivooi to
become)

D. Peter and the apostles continued their preaching in spite of opposition. vs.25
1. News of their preaching was reported to the Jewish leaders.
2. They were found standing and teaching the people (Israel)

E. The captain and his attendants captured the apostles.
1. They brought them before the Jewish leaders.
a. They brought them without force.
b. They feared they would be stoned by the people.
2. They led them into the council (Sanhedrin). vs. 27
a. The high priest questioned them concerning their charge not to teach in
Christs name. vs.28
* The phrase translated Did not we straitly command you can better be
translated with a charge, we charged you
* The word charge is tooco to command, to charge. Often
used as a legal term indicating a summons to court or the complaint
31
against the defendant. Reinecker/Rogers
* Christs name is cti te ovooti toute upon the character of
this one. (The message of Christs name was that He is one who has
the character to savea reality that threatened the hierarchy of the
Judism).
- Faith in his name brought healing. Acts 3:16
- Faith in his name saves. Acts 4:12; 8:12
- The apostles suffered for his name. Acts 5:41; 9:16

b. The leaders were concerned they had filled Jerusalem with their teaching.
vs.28a (fulfilling Christs command Acts 1:8)
c. The leaders were concerned they intended to place the blamefor Christs
death upon them.vs.28b
* The word intend is |oucoOc to determine.
* The term Bring this mans blood upon us.
3. The apostles affirm the necessity of continuing their message. vs.29
a. Peter points out the necessity to obey (ticOo_civ to obey a ruler or a
superior) God. (ill. 2 Co. 1:9; Gal. 1:10)
b. Peter points out the necessity of not obeying man over God.
4. Peter gives a short narrative of the Jews history in hopes of bringing
repentance.vs.30-32
a. Peter connects Jesus and the Jews by stating The God of our fathers -- a
term used consistently in sermons to the Jews. (Acts 3:13; 7:32; 13:17;
15:10; 22:14; 26:6 ;)
b. God raised up the Jesus whom you killed by hanging Him on a tree. vs.30
c. God exalted Him to His right hand.
* God exalted Him to be a ruler. Lk. 1:69-74
* God exalted Him to be a savior. Matt. 1:21
* God exalted Him for the purposeof giving repentance to Israel.
-- John proclaimed. Acts 13:24; 19:4
-- Israel, as a whole, didnt repent. (ill. Matt. 11:16-24)
-- Israel will repent in the future. Zec.
* God exalted Him to give forgiveness of sins.
e. The apostles were witnesses of the things God did. (ill. Acts 1:8; 10:37-41;
2:32; 3:15)
f. The Holy Spirit was witness to the things of whom God gave to the ones
obeying Him. (ill. John 14:16-17; Acts 1:4-5)
5. The Jewish leaders were unimpressed by the connection made to their forefathers.
vs.33
a. They were cut (Aictiovto to saw through, to cut to the quick, to
infuriate) to the heart upon hearing Peter. (ill. 7:54)
b. They determined (|ouq) to kill the apostles.
6. Gamaliel, the chief Pharisee averts the apostles death. vs.34

(Gamaliel was of a sect of the Pharisees -- conservative J ews. He was a
teacher/interpreter of the Mosiac law. The apostle Paul studied under him. He was
32
the greatest teacher of his day (Acts 22:3). He was president of the Sanhedrin.
One of seven J ewish doctors of the law termed Rabbi. Tradition states that he later
became a Christian) Notes on the Book of Acts Dale Spurbeck.
a. Gamaliel commanded the apostles be put outside the council.
b. Gamaliel warned the Jews concerning their actions.
* He cautioned the Men of Israel to take heed to themselves (reflexive
pronoun ill. 1 Tim. 2:16).
* He reminded the Jews of another insurrection that failed. vs.36-37
* He reminded the Jews that the actions of the apostles would fail if it
were motivated by men. vs. 38
* He warned the Jews that they could not overthrow the work of God.
vs.39
7. The Jews were obedient to Gamaliel. vs.40
a. They called the apostles.
b. They beat (e.ta|., to flog, beat. The punishment was for minor
offensesActs 16:37; 22:19) the apostles.
c. They charged the apostles not to speak in His name.
d. They released the apostles.
8. The apostles counted directed joy in the midst of their oppression. Vs. 41-42
a. They departed from the presence of the Jews rejoicing (_oiovtco a
mental contentment with trying and difficult circumstances Col. 1:24; 2
Co. 7:5- 7).
b. They were counted worthy to suffer for His name.
c. They ceased not to teach Jesus Christ.
d. They ceased not to preach Jesus Christ.
e. They taught in the temple and in homes by this time.




















33



Chapter 6



I. THE APPOINTMENT OF DEACONS WAS PIVITOL IN THE GROWTH OF THE EARLY
CHURCH.
A. The growth of the early church presented logistical problems for the apostles. vs.1
1. The disciples multiplied.
a. The word multiplied is the Greek word tqOuvovtev to fill, to
increase, abound.
b. The word is used throughout the book of Acts denoting the growth of the
church.
* It is used to denote the number of disciples increasing. Acts 6:1,7
* It is used of the Word of God increasing. Acts 12:24
2. The growth of the church brought about murmuring of the Hellenist believers against
the Hebrew believers.
a. The Hellenist was one, not of the Greek nation, who spoke Greek. The term
is used specially of J ews who had adopted the Greek tongue, and with it
often Greek practices and opinions. Probably these J ews spoke only Greek
and no Semitic language. The text calls them Grecian J ews; and the AV
simply Grecians. --- Westminister Dictionary of The Bible. (Acts 9:29)
b. The Hebrew is a name applied to the Israelites.
c. The word murmuring denotes a grumble; say anything in a low tone; of
those who discontentedly complain. Joseph Thayer (ill. 1 Co.10: 10; John
7:32)
* The murmuring began because their (Hellenist) widows were
overlooked (The idea behind the word denotes that they were
intentionally neglected, continually)
* The neglect occurred in the daily service of the widows.
- The church provided for widows from the things given to
the church by individual believers. (ill. Acts 4:34)
- The widows played a pivotal role in the early church. (ill Acts
9:39)
- There was a standard for who was accepted into the role as a
widow. 1 Tim. 5:3-16

B. The apostles provided a solution to the problem. vs.2
1. They called the multitude of the disciples together.
a. Notice the twelve denotes the 11 disciples plus Matthias who replaced
Judas this number grew as the church grew and the name of their position
also changed.
b. They emphasized the problems with leaving (kotocito to leave
behind, to abandon aor. part. Ill. Eph. 5:31) the Word of God to do
34
service.
c. They instructed the multitude of disciples to select men whose purpose would
be to conduct this service.
2. The disciples were to look ye out (ctiokc|ooOc to oversee, supervise ill.
Heb. 12:15; 1 Pet. 5:2)
3. The standard for serving as deacons was three fold. vs.3a
a. The number to be selected to serve was seven men of an honest report
(Motuce- to give testimony, to bear witness, to be well reported
of ill. 1 Tim. 5:10)
b. Those serving had to be ones (being full continually filled) by the Holy
Spirit.
c. Those serving had to be ones (being full- continually filled) with wisdom
(being able to properly apply the knowledge ill 2 Co.1: 12; Acts 6:10)
4. Those who met the standard were chosen by the majority with the 12 disciples
appointing them to the office. 3b
a. The congregation selected deacons.
b. The disciples appointed (kotqiotqi to appoint; give their approval to the
congregations selection)

C. The appointment of deacons to an office of service freed the apostles to devote their time to
teaching. vs.4
1. The phrase give ourselves continually is tookotcqooucv to hold fast to,
to continue in. (ill. Acts 2:42,46)
2. The appointment allowed the apostles to continue in worshipping (prayer). vs. 4a
3. The appointment allowed the apostles to continue in the service (ministering) of the
Word. vs.4b

D. The multitude was in agreement with the apostles solution. vs.5
1. The multitude was pleased with the solution.
2. The multitude (indication of church authority) chose (ckce to select, to choose
ill. Mark 13:20; John 6:70) out seven men. (All seven names are Greek in origin and
may have been a Hellenist some think)
a. Stephen (had the gift of pastor/teacher)
* He was full of faith.
* He was full of the Holy Spirit.
b. Phillip (had the gift of evangelism)
c. Prochorus
d. Nicanor
e. Timona
f. Parmenas
g. Nicolaus was a Jewish proselyte who then converted to Christianity. His
name means one who rules the people.
3. They set the seven before the apostles. vs.6
a. The apostles prayed over them.
b. The apostles laid hands (a ritual used in the early church by the apostles of
identifying with or authenticating someone ill. Acts 8:18; 1 Ti. 4:14; 2
35
Ti. 1:6; Heb. 6:2) on them.

E. The solution of the apostles was directly related to the continued progress of the church. vs.7
1. The term and denotes a connection to the activities of verse 6.
2. The Word of (from) God
a. A summation of the Word of God is illustrated by the apostles Paul and
Peter.
* Peter outlined the thrust of the Word of God in his message to the
household of Corneilus. Acts 10:34-43
* Paul gave insight into the message of the Word of God in his
message to the church of Antioch in Pisidia. Acts 13:15-44
b. The Word of God was verbalized in the early formation of the Church.
(ill. Acts 4:4; 8:25; 13:4-5,46; 15:35-36)
c. The Word from God grew (spread) Acts 12:24; 19:20
d. The Word of the Lord is a part of the Word of God.
3. The number of the disciples in Jerusalem multiplied (tqOuvo to increase Acts
6:1; 7:17; 9:31).
4. Many of the (Jewish) priests were obedient to the Faith.



II. STEPHEN EXHIBITED EXTRAORIDNARY SPIRITUAL MATURITY.
A. The Lord used Stephen mightily. vs.8
1. He was full of faith trusting God at His word.
2. He was full of power -- ability. (ill. Acts 1:8; 3:12)
3. He did signs and wonders among the people (Israel)

B. Stephens spiritual maturity caused envy among the Jews. vs.9
1. Certain ones of the synagogue of the Libertines (J ews who, having been taken
prisoners in battle by Pompey and other Roman generals, had been bondsmen at
Rome, but were afterward restored to liberty) debated with Stephen.
a. Some were from Cyrenian (An important Greek colony city in North Africa;
many J ews became resident there in 3
rd
century B.C. WDTB)
b. Some were from Alexandria (An Egyptian city founded by Alexander the
Great in 332 B.C. -- WDTB)
c. Some were from Cilicia (a district in the s.e. corner of Asia Minor; the chief
town was Tarsus, birthplace of the Apostle Paul -- WDTB)
d. Some were from Asia
2. Those debating with Stephen didnt have the strength to withstand him. vs.9-10
a. The word debating is the Greek word cu,eu|., (pres. part.) which
denote to contend against a stated position for the purpose of underminding
it. Context of Scripture (ill. Mk. 12:19-28; Acts 15:1-2)
b. The word strength is io_uov faculty, ability. Sheldon Green (ill. 1
Pet.4: 11)
c. They couldnt withstand (ovtiqiotii to stand against, successfully
withstand) his wisdom (how to apply what he knew about the Old
36
Testament Scriptures and how they related to the Dispensation of Grace)
d. They couldnt withstand the Spirit by which he spoke. (ill. 1 Pet. 4:11)

C. Stephens tormentors resorted to lying in order to extract retribution for their inability to
undermine the Word of God.
1. They suborned men who spoke lies about Stephen. vs.11
a. The word suborned is uto|ooe which means to put up, to prompt. It
applies to the secret instigation of persons who are supplied with
suggestions of what they are to say, much as in the modern frame up
Reinecker/Rogers.
b. These men claimed Stephen spoke blasphemous utterances against Moses.
c. These men claimed Stephen spoke blasphemous utterances against God.
2. They stirred up (ouvckivqoov -- to throw into a commotion, to stir violently) the
Jews with their accusations. vs.12
a. The elders and the scribes seized him.
b. They led him to the council.

D. The witnesses to Stephens supposed blasphemous statements continued their lies. vs.13-14
1. They claimed that he spoke blasphemous words against the synagogue.
2. They claimed that he spoke blasphemous words against the law.
3. They claimed that he said Jesus of Nazareth would destroy the temple.
4. They claimed that he said Jesus of Nazareth would change the customs (cOov
custom, institute, rite Acts 15:1; Lk.): 42) which Moses delivered to the Jews.

E. The witness of Stephen had an impact on his tormentors. vs.15
1. They gazed at him while sitting in the council.
2. They saw the face of him as the face of an angel.



















37



Chapter 7


I. STEPHENS DEFENSE INCLUDES AN HISTORICAL NARRATIVE OF THE BASIS FOR
ISRAELS HOPE. vs. 1-8
A. The high priest quizzes Stephen over the accusations. vs.1

B. Stephen begins his narrative with Gods appearance to Abram after all of mankind rebelled
at the tower of Babel. vs.2
1. The God of Glory appeared (E|q -- from oraw which means to appear; to reveal
ones self ill. Acts 26: 16) to father Abraham.
a. He appeared to Abraham while he was in Mesopotamia. (present day Iraq)
b. He appeared to Abraham before he dwelt (kotoikce settled down and
felt at ease permanently) in Charran. (ill. Gen. 12:1)
Note:
Charran was a city of Mesopotomia, on the Balikh, an affluent
Of the Euphrates, about 240 miles w. by n. from Nineveh and 280 n.n.e.
of Damascus. It was a commercial center, being on one of the main
trade routes between Babylonia and the Mediterranean;, and, like Ur of
the Chaldees, had the moon-god for its patron deity.

2. Gods gave Abraham particular instructions. vs.3
a. He was told to go forth out of this land.
b. He was told to go forth out of his kindred (oucvcio kinship, relatives).
c. He was told to come into the land which God would shew (ocie
grapically display to him)
3. Abraham disobeyed Gods instructions to him. vs.4-5
a. He went out from the land of the Chaldeans (In the Neo-Babylonian Empire
the Chaldeans were the dominat race, and doubtless possessed themselves
of all offices of influence. Westminster Dictionary of the Bible) and dwelt
in Charran. vs.4a
b. God used the death of his father to remove him out Charran into the land
wherein ye now dwell. vs.4b
* God removed (ctekiocv to cause to dwell, to settle (for the idea
of transfer or change).
- into the (this) land (the promised land)
- into which ye now dwell (kotoikcitc settle down and feel at
home)
* He didnt give him an inheritance in it.
* He didnt give him as to set his foot on (Bqo :eee, space
which the foot covers, a foot-breadth)
* Yet, he promised (aor. mid.) him:
-that he would give it to him for a possession (kotoo_coiv to
38
hold downright, hold in a firm grasp to have in full and secure
possession).
-that he would give it to his seed after him (when as yet he had
not child).
4. God made other promises to Abraham.vs.6-8a
a. God promised that his seed would sojourn (:aetse|
foreign, alien, Sojourner Reinecker/Rogers) in a strange land. Gen.
15:2,13
b. God promised that those in the land where the dwelt would bring them into
bondage (oouoe -- to serve as a slave, to be enslaved) Ex. 1:1-14
c. God promised that those who placed his seed in bondage would treat them
evil for four hundred years. Ex.3: 5-8
d. God promised that he would judge the nation who enslaves them. (ill. Ex.
Chapters 7-9)
e. God gave him the covenant of circumcision (3
rd
covenant Gen. 17:10-13)
5. The first three generations from Abraham included:
a. Isaac
b. Jacob
c. The twelve patriarchs (the sons of Jacob/Israel)


II. STEPHEN CHRONICLES GODS FAITHFULNESS TO THE NATION. vs. 9-16
A. God uses the ill-will of the patriarchs to fulfill his promise to Abraham. vs.9-10
1. The Patriarchs sold Joseph because of their envy (,. ca|., to boil with
zeal, then with envy; to be jealous). ill. Gen. 37:3-27
2. God delivered Joseph out of all his afflictions. vs. 10
a. God delivered (ccioto to take out, to tear out, to deliver
Reinecker/Rogers)
* Out (ek) from.
* All his afflictions (Oi|cev pressures, compression; distress of
mind)
b. He gave him favour (xarin grace) in the sight of Pharaoh. Gen. 39:21-23
c. He gave him wisdom in the sight of Pharoh. Gen. 41:1-36
d. Pharaoh gave made him governor over Egypt and his entire house. Gen.
41:37-46

B. Josephs position is used by God to deliver his family out from severe drought conditions.
vs. 11-16
1. A dearth (famine te,scarcity of food, want of grain) came over Egypt and
Canaan. vs.11a
2. Our fathers (the patriarchs) found (quiokov to find imperf.) no food
(_otoooto food; originally of animals, foodstuffs. Later in the sense of
mens food as well Reinecker/Rogers) vs.11b
3. Jacob heard (aor. part. continually hearing at a point in time) that there was corn in
Egypt. vs. 12a (Gen. 41:56-57; 42:1-2)
a. He sent the patriarchs into Egypt. vs.12b (Gen. 42:3)
39
b. Joseph was made known (ovcveioOq -- to make known, reveal, declare
Sheldon Green aor. pass.) to the patriarchs on the second visit. (Gen. 45:1)
c. Joseph sent to call his father and kindred to Egypt. Gen. 45:9-13
d. Jacob went to Egypt and died there as well as the fathers. Gen. 46:1-7; 49:29-
33
e. They all were carried over into Sychem and buried in Abrahams tomb. Gen.
50:13


III. STEPHEN REMINDS HIS TORMENTORS THAT MOSES PROPHESIED ABOUT THE
ONE IN WHOM HE (STEPHEN) HAD PUT HIS TRUST. vs. 17-38
A. The presence of the Israelites in Egypt brought fear to the Pharoah of Egypt. vs.17-19
1. The people (Israel) grew as the time of the promise drew near. vs.17
a. The word time is _ovo= which emphasizes occurrence in sequential
order. (ill. Acts 1:6,7; 3:21; Gen. 4:4)
b. The word declared is eooqocv means to agree, to promise.
2. The people (Israel) multiplied in Egypt.
3. Another king arose who didnt know Joseph. vs.18
a. The word another is qctcov a king of a different kind (J osephus in his
Antiquity of the J ews denotes that the king of a different kind denoted the
beginning of a new dynasty)
b. The word know is the word hdei is from oida, to know the facts about it
is in the pluperfect which can be translated he did not know J oseph at all
in the past and did not know him when he took control.
4. The new king treated the Israelites badly. vs.19
a. He dealt subtily (kotooo|ioocvo to exploit, to deal wisely, it implies
crafty or deceitful ill treatment) with the Israelites. Ex. 1:9-11
b. He treated the patriarchs evil entreated by making them exposed their
babes in order that they might die.
* evil entreated is the term that denotes that he treated with a
lacking in characterness for his own benefit. (ill Acts 18:10 of those
doing harm to Paul).
* exposed is the term ckOcto which means to expose, cast out or
abandon. (ill. Ex. 1:15-16)

B. God sent Moses to be deliverer of Israel.
1. Moses was born during the time (kairos a season of time) in which many of the
Israelite babies were being esposed. vs.20-21 (Ex. 2:1-10)
a. He was born fair (asteios belonging to a city; well-bred, polite, polished;
elegant, fair, comely, beautiful. Sheldon Green
b. He was nourished up (ovcto|q to nurse up, nourish up; of young
children and animals nourished to promote their growth) three months in
the house of his father. (Ex. 2:1-2)
c. Pharaohs daughter took (ovcioto to lift up; used of acknowledging or
adopting as ones child) him when he was esposed. vs.21 (Ex. 2:3-9)
d. Pharaohs daughter reared (nourished him through a nurse maid) Moses
40
as her son. (Ex. 2:9-10)
2. Moses was learned (ctoiocuOq to train a child; to instruct used of Grace
teaching 1 Tim. 1:20; 2 Tim. 2:25; Tit. 2:12) in the royalty of the Egyptians. vs.22
a. He was learned in all the wisdom of the Egyptians.
b. He was mighty (Dunatos to be able, powerful, mighty ill. Acts 18:24):
* In words denotes an ability to speak well. (ill. 1 Co. 1:17; 2:4,13)
* In deeds denotes anything done; a deed, work, action ill. 2 Pet.
2:8; 2 John 11; Rom. 15:18
3. Moses thought his Egyptian connections would be the thing that God would use to
free the Israelites from oppression. vs.23-24
a. It came into his heart (ovo|oive to go up, to come up. Used of things
coming up into ones mind). to visit his brethren when he was forty.
b. He killed an Egyptian who was treating an Israelite unjustly.
* The term suffer wrong is ooikoucvov which means to wrong, to
act unjustly toward; to suffer injustice. (Ex. 2:11-12)
* He avenged him that was oppressed (kototovoucvo to subdue,
to torment, to oppress.
* He supposed (voi,e to own as settled and established; to deem;
to suppose, presume 1 Tim. 6:5)
* The term understand (ouvqi to comprehend, understand
put together Eph. 5:17)
* Moses thought that God would deliver them by his hand (by his
physical proweress)
* The Israelites didnt understand that God would use Moses.
4. Moses is made to flee Egypt. vs.26-29
a. He appeared to two Israelites who were fighting one another. vs.26
* The term shewed (is from ooe to reveal oneself see vs.1)
* He attempted to set them at one again (reconcile them into peace)
* He quizzed them as to why they were unjustly treating one to
another (another of the same kind fellow Israelite)
b. The Israelites made it known they had witnessed his murder of the Egyptian.
vs. 27-28
* The one unjustly treating his neighbour (note another Jew) thrust
(oteOcooi to thrust away, repel from ones self, repulse Rom.
11:1,2; 1 Tim. 1:19) him away.
* The one unjustly treating his neighbor ask Moses:
- Who made thee a ruler (oovto ) over us?
- Who made thee a judge (Aikootqv one who passes
judgment in matters) over us?
- Wilt (Occie to wish, desire) you kill (ovcciv a
compound word made up of ovo up and oice to raise; the
idea is to take up, lift as from the ground; to take away or off,
put to death, kill, murder Heb. 10:9) in the same manner as
you killed the Egyptian yesterday?
c. Moses fled to Midian upon learning others knew about his murder of the
Egyptian.
41
* He became a sojourner (paraoikos -- one who lives in a place
without the right of citizenship Joseph Thayer Eph. 2:19; 1 Pet.
2:11) in Midian.
* He begat two sons in Midian.
5. God appeared to Moses forty years later. vs.30
a. The term expired is tqoeOcvtev is used to denote a fixed time frame
appointed by God was filled.
b. God appeared (ooe gives prominence to the discerning mind, denotes
perception in general as resulting principally from vision Joseph Thayer)
to Moses in the desert.
c. God appeared to him on the mount (which is called) Sinai (located in the
peninsula of Arabia Petraea)
d. God appeared to him as an angel. (similar to other O.T. appearances of the
pre-incarnate Son of God Gen. 21; 17-19; Judges 14:16-22)
e. God appeared to him in a flaming fire in a thorn bush.
6. Moses was intrigued by the bush.vs.31
a. He marveled (cOoo,cv to wonder, to be amazed) at the sight of it.
b. He approached the bush to to behold it. (kotovoqooi to take knowledge
of, to take notice, to master the mystery ill. Matt. 7:3)
c. A voice of (from a) Lord came (to) him.
7. The Lord explained to Moses the promises made to Abraham and his role in
fulfilling them. vs.32-34
a. God announced who He was (Ee e .e, I on my part am The God of
your fathers. vs.32
b. Moses trembled (entromos - used to describe the anxiety of one who
distrusts his ability completely to meet all requirements, but religiously
does his utmost to fulfill his duty -- 1 Co. 2:3)
c. Moses did not durst (dare) take notice of the bush.
d. Moses was instructed to take off his shoes. vs.33
e. God announced his purpose for talking to Moses. vs.34
* God I have seen (better translated seeing I saw to turn the eyes,
the mind, the attention to anything; to pay attention, observe) the
affliction (kokeoiv acts of evil for personal gain) of His people
in Egypt.
* God heard (aor.) the groaning (otcvo,e groaning or sighing
due to intense exertion Rom. 8:23; 2Co. 5:2) of His people in Egypt.
* God came down (kotcBqv to come down; used of members of the
Godhead coming to earth Matt. 3:16; Lk. 2:51; 10:31) to rescue
them.
* God sent Moses into Egypt.
8. God sent Moses to Egypt for two purposes. vs.35
a. God sent Moses to Egypt to be a ruler (commander, chief leader).
b. God sent Moses to Egypt to be a deliverer (liberator).
c. God sent Moses by the hand (_cii it is an idiom used to denote the
power and strength or authority of one Acts 11:21; Lk. 23:46; Mk. 14:41)
of the angel, which appeared to him in the bush.
42
9. God brought the Israelites out of Egypt through Moses using signs and wonders.
vs.36
a. God showed signs and wonders in Egypt. (Ps. 105: 26-41)
b. God showed signs and wonders in the Red Sea. (Ex. 14:12-27)
c. God showed signs and wonders in the wilderness.
d. God showed these signs for forty years.

C. Stephen connects the legitimacy of Christ to the credibility of Moses, a man the Jews
revered.
1. Moses prophesied that God would raise up a prophet out from his brethren like him.
vs.37 (Deut. 18:15)
a. The prophet was promised to come out from among the Jew.
b. The prophet was promised to be similar to Moses.
* The law was given by Moses Grace and truth through Jesus. John
1:17
* Moses had a house (Israel) that he was over (Heb. 3:5) Christ has a
house that He is over (Heb. 3:6)
2. The prophet that Moses prophesied was the same one who was: vs.38
a. In the assembly in the wilderness. (Ex. 40:34-38)
b. With (cto loosely associated with --the angel speaking to him on the
Mount Sinai. (vs.30)
c. With the fathers who received the oracles to give unto Israel. (Deut. 9:10-13)


IV. STEPHEN CHRONICLES ISRAELS PERSISTENT REJECTION OF THE WILL OF GOD.
vs. 39-50
A. Israels rejection of Jehovah excelled at Mount Sinai. vs. 39
1. They didnt desire (Oce constative aor. denotes that they never desired)
to become (aor. mid. Inf. become for themselves) obedient to Him.
2. They thrust Him away from them.
3. They turned in their hearts into Egypt. vs. 42-43 (Num. 14:1-5; Ex. 32:1,23)
a. The focus of the heart affects direction. (ill. Acts 5:4; 28:27; Eph.3: 7)
b. Israel made idol gods to go before them (totocuoovtoi to go
before, to precede, as J ehovah had gone before them in the pillar of
cloud and as images were carried by the heathen in their marches).
c. Moses had been on the mount for so long they didnt believe he would
return.
* The word translated know (oioo to know the facts about a
matter).
* The phrase what is become of him (ti ccvcto oute, what has
come to be with him.)
* They became idol worshippers. vs.41
-They made a calf.
-They brought up sacrifices to the idol.
-They rejoiced (were made merry) by the works
of their (very own) hands
43
c. God turned and delivered them to worship the host of heaven. vs.42
(Jer. 8:2; 19:13)
*The term host (ototio -- is used in Scripture to denote armies
both of men and spirit beingsboth good and bad. (ill.1 Sam. 28:5;
Deut. 4:19; Lk. 2:13;)
* God gave them up (toooiooi to hand over, deliver up ill.
Rom. 1:24,26)
* God deported them into Babylon for their disobedience. vs.43 (ill.
Amos 5:20-27)
- The served the God Molech, which was a diety, worshiped by
the children of Ammon (1Kings 11:7); and an exceedingly
detestable feature of Molechs worship was the burning of
children to him in the fire. The practice was in vogue early;
and the Mosaic law was enacted that if any man made or
permitted his children to pass through the fire of Molech he
was to be put to death (Lev. 18:21). -- DNTT
- They served the God Remphan which was a god who has a
star associated with him and who was worshipped by the
Isralites in the wilderness DNTT
- The term deport is ctoiki,e to remove to a new abode, to
cause to migrate.
.
B. Stephen reminds his persecutors that it was Israel with whom Jehovah dwelt after they
left Egypt. vs.44-45
1.The Fathers of Israel had the Tabernacle of Witness.
a. The term Fathers is used to denote the patriarchs of Israel.
b. The Tabernacle of Witness (a moveable sanctuary in the form of a tent,
which God directed Moses at Sinai to make, that God might dwell as king
among his people. (Ex.25: 8-9; Num. 16:18-19)
* It was in the wilderness.
* Jehovah instructed Moses to make it according to the type which he
had seen. (Ex. 25:9; Heb. 9:24)
2. Stephen informs the Jews that Jesus was the one in the tabernacle with Israel
in the wilderness.
a. The Fathers after the wilderness experience received the tabernacle.
b. The Fathers after the wilderness experience brought the tabernacle
with Jesus (dwelling in it) in the possession of the nations whom God
put out.
* from before the face of our fathers
* unto the days of David.

C. David desired to build Jehovah a tent to dwell in. vs.46
1. David had found (eureka favor) with God.
2. David asked to find a tent for the house of Jacob.
3. Davids son Soloman built a house for Jehovah. vs.47

44
D. Stephen emphasizes the immensity of Jehovah stretches beyond buildings. vs.48-50
1. The term the Most High denotes
2. He does not dwell (kotoikci dwell) in temples made with hands.
3. Old Testament Scripture describes Gods immensity. (ill. Is. 66:1)
a. Heaven is His throne.
b. Earth is His footstool.
4. His hands (anthropomorphism for His power or providence ill. Lk. 1:66) has
made all things.


V. STEPHEN OUTLINES THE BASIS FOR ISRAELS STATUS WITH JEHOVAH. vs. 51-53
A. They were stiff-necked (okqotoqoi -- to be hard hearted. Heb. 3:8,13,15; 4:7)

B. They were uncircumcised in heart (ill. Rom. 2:28-29)

C. They always resist the Holy Spirit as their fathers did. (ill Is. 63:10)
1. Their fathers persecuted the prophets in the Old Testament. (2 Chron. 36:11-13)
2. Their fathers killed the ones announcing before hand the coming of the just one.
(Matt. 23:29-30)
3. The Jews with whom Stephen was talking followed in the footsteps of their
fathers by killing the Just One whom the prophets prophesied. vs. 52
a. They betrayed Him
b. They murdered Him.

D. They never kept the law. vs.53
1. They received it by the disposition (oiotoq -- angels were employed as Gods
assistants in the solemn proclamation of the Mosaic law Gal. 3:19; Heb. 2:2) of
angels
2. They did not keep (c|uootc -- to observe, to keep Acts 15:10) the law.


VI. STEPHEN WAS MARTYRED FOR HIS TESTIMONY. vs. 54-60
A. Stephens message had a tremendous affect on the Jews hearing him. vs.54
1. They were cut to the heart (oictiovto to cut to the quick Acts 5:33))
2. They gnashed (cBuov -- to bite with a loud noise, to grind)
their teeth upon (cti in the accusative is translated at or towards) him.

B. Stephens response to the Jews anger made them more angry. vs.55
1. He was full (:, one filled with whats lacking ill. Lk. 4:1; Acts 11; 24)
of the Holy Spirit.
2. He looked (a.|t,. to fix eyes upon) into (the) heaven.
a. He saw (a quality of) glory of (belonging to) God.
b. He saw Jesus standing out (ek) (normally sitting Col. 3:1 Heb. 1:13; 12:2)
of the right hand of God
3. He related what he was seeing to the Jews. vs.56
a. He said behold I see the heavens opened
45
b. He said and I see the Son of man standing (out) at the right hand of (the)
God.

C. Stephens comments left the Jews in a rage. vs.57-58
1. They cried out with a great voice. vs.57
2. They stopped (ouvco_ov to hold together, to stop the ears) their ears.
3. They ran (eqoov to rush)
a. upon him.
b. with one accord
4. They cast (ck|oovtco -- to cast) him outside the city. (the procedure for
blasphemy was to take the offender outside the city for stoning). Lev. 24:10-14;
Num.15: 35)
5. They stoned him. vs.58
a. There were witnesses to the stoning.
b. They laid their garments at the feet of a young mans (=coviou youth,
one who is in the prime and vigour of life Acts 20:9) feet whose name
was Saul.

D. Stephens response was consistent with his manner of life. vs.59-60
1. He called upon God.
2. He was saying Lord Jesus receive (Acoi to welcome, receive) my spirit.
3. He kneeled down
4. He cried with a loud voice
a. Lord
b. Do not lay this sin
c. To their charge
5. He fell asleep


















45


CHAPTER 8



I. GOD USES THE FIRST MAJOR PERSECUTION OF THE CHURCH TO SPREAD THE
GOSPEL OUTSIDE JERUSALEM.
A. Saul the Pharisee was one of the main instigators of persecuting Christians. vs. 1a
(Acts 22:3-5; 26: 9-11; Gal. 1:13)
1. He was consenting (ouvcuookce to approve, to have pleasure with --Rom.
1:32; Acts 22:20)
2. The word used for kill is ovoicoci (murder).

B. The persecution of the Church in Jerusalem caused many to leave. vs.1b
1. The word persecution is Aieoo which means emphasizes to be pursued. Acts
26:11; 22:4
2. All were scattered (oicotoqoov -- to scatter abroad, disperse) Ja. 1:1; 1 Pet. 1:1
3. The apostles remained behind.

C. Stephen was buried. vs.2
1. Devout (EuoBqo taking hold well, i.e. carefully and surely cautious Joseph
Thayer Acts 2:5) men recovered his body.
2. Great lamentation (kotctov beating of the breast as a sign of grief Joseph
Thayer ) was made over him.

D. Saul made havoc (cuoivcto to devastate, to ruin. Used of physical injury,
particularly of the mangling by wild beast the imperfect pictures the continual action)
the Church in Jerusalem. vs.3
1. He entered into each house. (koto oikov according to house)
2. He hailed (ouev to draw, to drag Joseph Thayer John 21:8) men and
women.
3. He committed them to prison.

E. Those scattered went everywhere (AiqOov --- to go through, pass through) preaching
the Word (tov oov -- ill. Acts 4:3-4).

F. Phillip journeyed to Samaria. vs.5-6
1. Samaria was the town Jesus had visited during his earthly ministry. (John 4:4-5)
2. Phillip preached the Christ (the one having been raised from the dead) unto
them.
3. The people gave heed (tooc_e used in the sense of paying attention and
giving a favorable response) to the things being said.
a. They gave heed because of the things they heard.
b. They gave heed because of the (sign) miracles he did.
4. Many were affected by Phillips miracles. vs.7
46
a. Unclean spirits were cast out.
b. Those taken with the palsies(weakened or disabled ) were healed.
5. There was great joy in the city.

G. A man named Simon desired to have Phillips abilities. Vs. 9-10
1. He practicing sorcery (ocuev one who practices sorcery, uses potions that
derive a supposed efficacy form magical spells, and professes to possess
supernatural power or knowledge, gained in any manner, especially through the
connivance of evil spirits. D.N.T.T) Ex. 7:11-12; Is. 47:9
a. He bewitched (ciotqi to astonish, to amaze, to cause one to be beside
himself Reinecker/Rogers -- ill. Mk. 5:42) the nation of Samaria.
b. He fashioned himself to be someone great.
c. The Samaritans had previously given heed (gave credence to) to him.
vs.10
* He was called the power (from) God. (He was putting himself on a
par with diety. ill. 1 Co. 1:24)
* He was characterized as being great.
d. The Samaritans had regard (listened to him). vs.11
* They regarded him because of the considerable time (long time)
hed been there.
*They regarded him because they were astonished by his sorceries.

H. The Samaritans turned away from Simon believing Phillip. vs.12
1. They believed his preaching:
a. Concerning the Kingdom of God.
*The Kingdom of God was the main focus of those spreading the Good
news in the early development of the Church.
*Christ spoke to the disciples concerning the kingdom before His
ascension. Acts 1:3
*Paul preached the kingdom to the Ephesians. Acts 20:25
*Regeneration is necessary to enter into the Kingdom of God today.
John 3:3
b. Concerning the name (the one being characterized) Jesus (the one who died
for sins) Christ (the one who was raised from the dead).
2. Both men and women were baptized. (The proper mode of baptism is illustrated in
Acts 8:38-39)

I. Simon himself believed also. vs.13
1. The emphatic use of the personal pronoun autos denotes the legitimacy of Simons
profession.
2. He was baptized.
3. He continued (tookotcev to persist in adherence to a thing to be
intently engaged in; attend constantly to Sheldon Green Acts 2:42) with Phillip:
a. He was beholding (Occe to be a spectator, to gaze on, contemplate; to
behold, view with interest and attention)Matt. 27:54-55 the great signs and
wonders being done.
47
b. He wondered (was beside himself over the signs and wonders).


II. RECEIVING THE HOLY SPIRIT WAS DIFFERENT IN THE EARLY STAGES OF THE
CHURCH THAN TODAY.
A. The apostles alone had authority to confer the Holy Spirit to new believers.
1. The apostles authority was illustrated in the salvation of the Samaritans. vs.14
a. The apostles at Jerusalem heard the Samaritans had received (welcomed)
the Word of God. vs.12
b. Peter and John were sent to the Samaritans.
2. Peter and John prayed for the Samaritans that they might (aor. act. subj) receive
the Holy Spirit. vs.15-16
a. They had been baptized into the name of The Lord Jesus.
b. The Holy Spirit had not fallen (ctitcttekoo to fall upon mentally or
spiritually Sheldon Green Lk. 1:12; Acts 10:10,44) upon them yet.
3. Conference of the Holy Spirit occurred as a result of the apostles identification with
those who believed. vs.17
a. They laid (ctctiOcoov to put, place, lay uponSheldon Green) they
hands upon them.
* The laying on of hands was used to denote identification. Acts 13:3
* The laying on of hands was performed by the apostles to confer the
Holy Spirit to new believers. Acts 19:6
* The laying on of hands was performed by the apostles to impart a
spiritual gift. 1 Ti. 4:14; 5:22; 2 Ti. 1:6
b. They received the Holy Spirit thru (the instrumentality of) the laying on of
hands.
c. There are four different ways the Holy Spirit was conferred upon four
different classes of people in the book of Acts.
* Believers at Pentecost. Acts 2:1-4
* The Samaritans. Acts 8:17
* The Gentiles. Acts 10:44-46
* The disciples of John the Baptist. Acts 19:6

B. The apostles reaction to Simons desire for the gift proved the gift was one
exclusive to the apostles.
1. He offered the apostles money. vs.18
2. He asked the apostles had to give me (ootc to grant, permit, allow) the Holy
Spirit. vs.19
3. Peter rebuked Simon for his desire for apostolic authority. vs.20
a. Peter requested that thy money perish (otoeciov to perish; to be
destroyed ill. Acts 5:37; Ro. 2:12; 14:15) with thee.
b. Simon supposed (cvoiooe -- to own as, settle, establish; to deem 1 Ti.
6:5; Matt. 5:17; Lk. 2:44) that to get the gift from God through money.
c. Simon didnt have part (ci,e share; participation 2 Co. 6:15; Col.
1:12).
d. Simon didnt have lot (kqoe -- a thing used in determining chances; a
48
constituent partition of the church Acts 26:18).
e. The term in this matter is cv te oe toute in the word (discourse); this
one. (ill. Acts 15:6)
f. Simons heart was not right (cuOcio -- upright; true Sheldon Green
Acts 13:10; 2 Pet. 2:15) before God. (ill. Ps. 78: 37 used of Israel)
g. Peter admonished Simon to do two things: vs.22
* Repent from this wickedness (kokioo of a bad quality or
disposition Sheldon Green Tit. 1:12; 1 Pet. 3:10).
* Pray God (ocqOqti petition, supplicate; cry for help)
h. Supplication to God brought about potential forgiveness. vs.22
*The term if perhaps is ci oo which denotes a means of uncertainty.
(Acts 17:27)
- ci represents a second-class condition assuming for the sake
of argument.
- oo denotes therefore, then, consequently; should it so
result. (Acts 17:27)
* Forgiveness is the word o|cOqi --send away; dismiss; suffer to
depart)
* Thought of thine heart is:
- cttivoio -- thought, intent, plot. Used in a bad sense of evil
or hostile schemes or stratagems. Reinecker/Rogers
- tqo kooio oou -- from the heart (literally. belonging to you)
g. Peter addresses the basis of Simons request. vs.23
*He saw that he was in a gall of bitterness denotes the venomous,
malignant feeling against what is good DNTT ill. Deut. 29:16-18))
* He saw that he was in a bond of unrighteousness
- ouvocoov that which binds together; a bundle. (denotes
the depth of how entrenched Simon was)
- ooikio that which is not right.
h. Simon asked supplication of Peter to avert the things, which he spoke
of him. vs.24

C. Peter and John returned to Jerusalem after helping to evangelize Samaria.
1. They had testified (oiootuocvoi to make solemn affirmation, protest, to
charge, exhort with entreaty; to testify or teach earnestly. Sheldon Green) the word
of the Lord.
2. They had preached (oqoovtcv to make an announcement or declaration
Sheldon Green Acts 14:25) the word of the Lord (ill. Acts. 13:26)
3. They returned into Jerusalem


II. THE ETHIOPIAN EUNUCH IS CONVERTED THROUGH THE MESSAGE OF PHILLIP.
A. Phillip is instructed to leave from Samaria to a location where he had an appointment with a
man from Ethiopia. vs.26 (Prophecy had been made concerning Ethiopia reaching out to
God. Ps. 68:32)
1. An angel from the Lord spoke to Phillip. vs.26
49
a. The angel told him to rise up.
b. The angel told him to go into the south:
*upon the way that goeth down fromJerusalem
* into Gaza which is the desert.
2. Phillips obedience to the angel led him into the pathway of a man from
Ethiopia.vs.27a

3. The Ethiopian was not a commoner. Vs.27b
a. He was a eunuch denotes one keeping or guarding the couch; persons who
have been emasculated; an impotent man. DNTT ill. Dan. 1:3; Esth.
1:10)
b. He was of great authority (ouvootqo a potentate, sovereign, prince; a
person of rank and authority. Sheldon Green) of Candace, queen of
Ethiopia. (ill. Lk. 1:52)
c. He was over all the treasure of Candace (general name for a queen in
Ethiopia).
d. He had come into Jerusalem for worship. (possibly a Jewish proselyte)
4. Phillip intersected with him on his return to Ethiopia. vs.28-29
a. He was sitting upon his chariot.
b. He was reading the prophet Isaiah.

5. Phillips encounter with the Ethiopian typifies the process of evangelism. vs.29-31
a. The Holy Spirit led Phillip to: vs.29
* Go near (tooquov go to or towards) the chariot
* To join (kooe -- to glue or weld together to adhere to; to attach
ones self to, unite with, associate.) thyself to this chariot
b. Phillip enquires as to the understanding the Ethiopian has concerning Isaiah.
vs.30
* The word for understand is the word ginowskw (experientially
know; have an acquaintance with).
* The use of the interrogative particle oo makes the translation of
Phillips comments: do you really know what you are reading?
(Dana & Mantey Grammar pg. 241)
c. The Ethiopian expresses a desire for understanding. vs.31
* The word for able is ouvoiqv to have an ability, power.
* Except some man should guide me
- The Greek word for guide is (ooqqoci to show the way, to
lead). Ill. John 16:13
- The translation some man is actually the adjectival use of the
indefinite pronoun, which is used to mention an act performed
by one without caring to specify his exact identity. Dana &
Mantey Grammar. ill. Lk. 22:35; Phil. 3:15
* He besought Phillip to come up and sit with him.
6. Phillip explained the passage in Isaiah 53:7-8 to the Ethiopian. vs.32-35
* Christ was prophesied as the suffering servant. vs. 32-33
* The term I pray thee in vs.34 is the Greek word (ocooi to stand
50
in need of want for ones self; to ask; to beg. Joseph Thayer ill.
Acts 21:39)
* Phillip began at (oto from) Isaiah 53 and preached to him (the)
Jesus (the one who would die for sin Mat. 1:21; Acts 9:20; 17:18;
18:5)

7. The Ethiopian requested to be baptized. vs.36

8. There is a textual problem with vs.37 (it is included by the TR when most
major manuscripts do not record it)
*The question by Erasmus was could Phillip baptize the Ethiopian
without knowing his belief.
* The answer is His belief was inferred in Scripture.

B. New Testament baptism is pictured in vs.38.
1. Both men descended into (eis) the water.
2. Phillip baptized (dipped) him.
3. Both men came up out (ek) of the water. vs.39a

C. Phillip is taken away by the Holy Spirit immediately after baptism. 39b-40
1. The word caught is the word used for the rapture qtoocv.
2. The Eunuch didnt see Phillip again.
3. The Eunuch went his way rejoicing.
4. Phillip was found (eureQh ---
* Azotus is a city eighteen miles south of Joppa, in Philistia. On
an elevation above the plain, was strongly fortified, and was one of the
seats of the worship of the god Dagon. Smiths Bible Dictionary.
* He evangelized the cities in that area till (ews up to the edge of)
he came into Caesarea.

















51


Chapter 9
(A.D. 32-39)


I. SAUL ENCOUNTERS THE RESURRECTED LORD ON THE ROAD TO DAMASCUS.
vs. 1-19
A. Sauls persecution of the church was intensifying when He met the Lord on the road to
Damascus. vs.1-2
1. The name Saul is Hebrew for: ask of God DNTT (His name is changed from
Acts 13:9 onward Paul is the Gentile pronunciation of the name)
2. Saul was yet breathing out threathenings and slaughter
a. The term breathing is (e,mpnewn to brethe into or upon: to respire, brethe;
to breathe of, be animated with the spirit of Sheldon Green)
b. Threatenings is.(apeilh harshness of languageSheldon Green Acts
4:17,29; Eph. 6:9
c. The term murder is (fo,nou a killing, a slaughter, murder.)
3. He approached the High Priest:
a. He asked them for letters for the synagogues in Damascus.
b. Any found in this way (the characteristic direction of life as determined by
faith on J esus Christ Marvin Vincent Acts 16:17; 19:9; 22:4;24:22;
28:25) he would bind and bring to Jerusalem.

B. A light from heaven shinned about him on his way to Damascus. vs.3-4
1. The light appeared as he drew near to Damascus (largest town in Syria).
2. There suddenly appeared to him a light shinning out around (periastraptw to
flash around Reinecker/Rogers) from heaven.
3. Saul fell upon the earth.
4. While falling upon the earth, Saul heard a voice saying:
a. Saul, Saul!
b. Why persecutest thou me? (God sees persecution of saints as persecuting
Him) vs.5.

C. Saul enquired as to whom he was speaking. vs. 5
1. Saul asked who art thou Lord?
2. He gets an answer: I am Jesus whom thou persecutest

D. The message of the Lord was specifically for Saul.vs.6 (also Acts 22:9)
1. Rise up.
2. Enter into the city.
3. Let it be told what is necessary (dei) to do.
a. dei denotes a logical necessity (Abbott & Smith). Heb. 2:1
b. dei is used in Hebrews to emphasize the need to heed our great salvation.
Heb. 2:1
c. dei is used in Hebrews to denote how essential it was to offer sacrifices under
52
law. Heb. 9:26
d. dei is used to denote the essential need to please God. Heb. 11:6; Rom. 8:26;12:3
E. The men traveling with had a different experience than Saul. vs.7
1. They stood speechless.
2. They heard the sound.
3. They were beholding (qewrountej -- to be a spectator, to gaze on, contemplate; to
behold, view with interest and attention; to contemplate mentally, considerMatt.
27:55) no man.

F. Saul reaches Damascus a changed man.vs.8-9
1. He was helped from the ground.
2. His eyes were opened but he could not see (Blepw to glance ).
(Note: The mention of the scales, or incrustations, such as are incidental to
ophthalmia an inflammation of the conjunctiva (the mucous membrane that
lines the inner surface of the eyelids and is continued over the forepart of the
eyeball) or the eyeball Marvin Vincent/Websters Dictionary

3. He was led by the hand by his traveling companions into Damascus.
4. Saul sight remained absent for three days.
5. Saul did not eat or drink for three days.

G. God used a man named Ananias to intergrate Saul into the brotherhood. vs. 10-17
1. Ananias was a disciple, possibly of Christ during His earthly ministry.
2. The Lord appeared to Ananias in a vision.
a. A vision is when the eyes are open but something else is in the line of sight.
(ill Numb. 24:4,15,16)
b. God used visions as a mechanism of revelation for the early Church. (Acts
c. Ananias was given instructions concerning Saul.
* He was to go to a street called Straight street (The traditional street
called straight is about 2 miles long, and runs from n.e. to s.w.,
almost through the center of the city. It is a poor street now, but it
the time of Paul it was a magnificent thoroughfare, flanked with
Corinthian columns DNTT).
* He was to give out to seek out Saul in the house of Judas.
3. Sauls filling was (pimplhmi mental enhancement, complete mental filling) vs.17

H. There is an elapse of time between Sauls forced departure from Damascus and his first visit
to Jerusalem. The gap probably occurs in Acts 9:19a
1. He receives his sight and strength.
2. He hadnt conferred (prosaneqemhn the gaining of information by communicating
with others Reinecker/Rogers) with flesh and blood. Gal.1:16
3. He hadnt made his first journey into Jerusalem. Acts 9:26; Gal. 1:17
4. He had apparently left Damascus and returned. Gal. 1:17
5. The word then (egeneto) accounts for a change in activities in 19:b.


53


I. Sauls began his ministry after getting acquainted with other disciples following his time in
Arabia. vs.19b
1.The word then is egeneto is used in Scripture to denote a gap in events here it is
used to denote Sauls second trip into Damascus after spending time in Arabia. (ill.
Acts 1:2; 11,16,17,19)
2. He spent time with the disciples certain days (The word certain is t|e, an
indefinite pronoun that indicates an unspecified amount of time).


II. SAUL WAS USED AMONG THE JEWS TO CONVINCE THEM THAT JESUS WAS THE
MESSIAH. vs. 20-31
A. Saul immediately preached in the Synagogue. vs.20
(Note: The origin of the synagogue is obscure, but the formal worship at Jerusalem was
impossible when most of the people were in exile in Babylon, and it seems to have
been then and there that synagogues first arose. They were designed to be places, not
of sacrifice, but of Scriptural instruction and prayer. DNTT)
1. He began his ministry immediately (.u.., instantly, at once, directly)
2. He preached (.succ.| heralded with authority2 Tim. 4:2) in the
synagogues.
a. He preached the Jesus.
b. He preached that He (Jesus) is the Son of (belonging to) God.

B. People were amazed by Sauls preaching. vs. 21
1. They were amazed (.tca|e to be beside ones self).
2. They questioned as to whether this was the same man who:
a. Destroyed (to ravage, to or sack a city, to destroy any human fellowship)
those in Jerusalem who involked (called upon) this name.
b. Came to Damascus to bind them that he might bring them bound unto the
chief priests?

C. Saul continued to grow. vs. 22
1. He increased the more in strength (enedunamouto --
2. He confounded (sunexunnen to confuse, to exercise constraining influence on
Reinecker/Rogers Lk. 19:43) the Jews dwelling in Damascus.
3. He was proving (sumbiabazwn the verb means to bring or put together: hence to
compare and examine, as evidence, and so to prove.) that this is (outoj this one
goes back to vs. 21,20) is the Christ (Messiah).

D. The Jews were unimpressed with Sauls newfound message. vs.23-25
1. Many days (ikanai hmerai -- were fulfilled). vs.22
2. The Jews took counsel (sunebouleu, santo determined together; decreedMatt.
26:4) to kill Saul. vs.23
3. Their lying in wait (epiboulh plot) was made known to Saul. vs.24
4. The Jews watched (parethrounto --- to watch, to observe) the gates (pu, laj) day
54
and night to kill him. (Paul counts this as one of his most tretcharous sufferings
2 Co. 11:32-33)
5. The disciples helped him escape. vs.25
a. They took him by night.
b. They let him down (dia by mean of a window 2 Co. 11:33)
c. They let him down in a basket.

E. The believers in Jerusalem were apprehensive about Sauls conversion. vs.26
1. Saul travel from Damascus to Jerusalem after his escape.
2. He assayed (e.pe, irazen to try, attempt impf. is used here to denote repeated
attempts) to join himself (kalla/sqai to be joined to, to keep company with Acts
5:13; 10:28) to the disciples. vs. 26a
3. All the disciples were afraid (efobounto of him) and believed not that he was a
disciple. vs. 26b

F. Barnabas led the way in giving Saul acceptance among the brethern. vs.27
1. Barnabas son of exhortation, encouragement, or consolation, which favors.
2. He took Saul and led him to the apostles.
3. He declared (dihghsato narrated, to relate, describe Acts 2:14; 3:18; 4:23) to
them:
a. How he had seen the Lord in the way.
b. That He spoke (elalhsen ---) to him.
c. He (Saul) spoke boldly (Acts 4:31; 13:46; 14:3; 18:26; 19:8) in the name of
Jesus in Damascus.

G. Saul continued with the apostles from that point. vs.28-29
1. He was with them coming in (eisporeuomenoj) to Jerusalem.
2. He was with them going out (ekporeuomenoj 13:42) of Jerusalem.
3. He spoke boldly in the name of the Lord (Acts 8:16; 10:48; 19:5).
4. He disputed (sunzhtei -- to mingle thought with thoughts; to converse; discourse
with one, argue; discuss -- Acts 9:29; 17:17) with the Grecians who attempted
to him.
a. When the brethren knew the brought him into Ceasarea.
b. They sent him into Tarsus.

H. The conversion of Saul brought rest throughout churches. vs. 31
1. The churches in Judea, Galilee and Samaria had peace.
2. The churches were edified.
3. The churches were walking in the fear of the Lord (Acts 13:16; Rom. 3:18;
11:20; Eph. 5:21)
4. The churches were in the comfort of the Holy Spirit (Col. 4:8; 2 Thess. 2:17)
5. The churches were multiplied

III. PETER IS DIRECTED TO GO TO TURN HIS ATTENTION TO THE GENTILES. vs.32-43
A. Peters mission takes him throughout the region. vs. 32
1. He passed throughout (go through, pass through different locations) all quarters
55
(Acts 12; 10; 14:24; 15:3; 17:1; 19:1,21)
2. He came down to the saints which dwelt at Lydda.
(Note: Lydda was a town 11 miles southest of J oppa)

B. Peter heals Aeneas in Lydda. vs. 33-35
1. The name Aeneas (was the name of a Trojan hero) means
2. He kept his bed eight years.
3. He was sick of the palsy (a partial or total loss of sensibility, voluntary motion, or
both in 1 or more parts of the body -- DNTT) ill. Mk. 2:3,9-12
4. Jesus (Christ) cured through Peter (ill. Heb. 2:4) Aeneas
5. Aneas healing affected those who saw (Acts 3:9; 4:14) him.
a. Those inhabiting Lydda and Sharon
b. They turned (1Thess.1: 9) to the Lord.

C. Peter heals Tabitha in Joppa. Vs. 36-42.
1. The name Dorcas is translated Tabitha in Aramaic. The name means gazelle.
2. Dorcas was characterized by her lifestyle. (ill. 1 Tim. 5:10)
a. She was one filled (plhrhj one filled up with what was lacking of good
beneficial works -- ill. Acts 6:8; 7:55)
b. She was one filled with alms (elehmosunwn- mercy, pity, the benefaction
itself, donation to the poor)
3. Dorcas became sick and died.
a. She was washed (ceremonial washing for purification)
b. She was placed in an upper chamber
4. Peter was in Joppa, which was near Lydda.
a. The disciples at Lydda sent for Peter.
b. The widows displayed (for themselves) the results of Dorcas good works.
* She made coats.
* She made garments.
5. Peter raised Dorcas from the dead. vs. 39-41
a. He placed everyone outside.
b. He knelt down and prayed.
c. He turned to the body and spoke.
d. Dorcas opened her eyes.
e. Seeing Peter, she sat up.
f. Giving her a hand, she raised up.
g. He presented her to the widows alive.

6. Dorcas miracle resulted in the conversion of many who heard of it. vs.42
a. The miracle became known (gnwston) throughout all of Joppa.
b. Many believed upon the Lord.

D. Peter minister in Joppa many days. vs.43
1. Peter remained in Joppa several days.
2. He resided with Simon, the tanner.

56


Chapter 10
(A.D. 41-51)




I. GOD VISITS CORNELIUS WITH INSTRUCTIONS THAT LEADS TO HIS CONVERSION.
A. Cornelius was a gentile and a member of the Roman army. vs.1-2
1. He lived in Caesarea, a city named in honor of the Roman emperor Tiberius Caesar.
vs.1
2. He was a centurion (of the Italian band).
a. A centurion is a soldier with authority over 100 men.
b. A band (speirhj a regiment made up on approximately 600 individuals
stationed across the Roman Empire where needed Sir William Ramsey)
3. He was a devout (eulabhj taking hold well, i.e. carefully and surely
cautious Joseph Thayer Acts 2:5) man. vs.2
4. He feared God (denotes reverence toward the God of Israel) with all his house.
(note: the terms devout and fear were used to denote Gentiles who, though not
full proselytes, attached themselves to the J ewish religion, practicing its
monotheistic and imageless worship Reinecker/Rogers)
5. He gave much alms (elehmosuhn to practice the virtue of mercy or
beneficence, to show ones compassion, often a donation to the poor among Israel
Joseph Thayer) to people.
6. He prayed (deomai to stand in need of, want for ones self, to ask for, to beg
Joseph Thayer) to God continually. (ill. Acts 8:34)

B. God spoke to Cornelius in a vision (ill. Numbers 24:4,15-16). vs.3
1. It occurred about the ninth hour (Three p.m. which was the J ewish time for prayer
Walvord/Zuck).
2. An angel came to him.
3. Cornelius was afraid of the angel.
4. The angel informed him of Gods message to him. vs.4
a. His worship and alms went up as a memorial (denotes it became know before
God, so that he heeded them and was about to help him) before God
b. He was to send (metapemfai (aor. mid. Imp.) the sending of another for
ones own sake) men to Joppa and call for Simon Peter.
* He was lodging with one Simon, a tanner.
* His lodging was by the seaside.
* Peter was to tell him what he was to do
5. Cornelius obeyed the angels message. vs.7-8
a. He called two of his household servants
b. He called a devout (one taking hold well, i.e. carefully and surely
cautious Joseph Thayer Acts 2:5
c. He declared (e, xhge, omai to draw out in narrative, unfold in teaching; also
57
used in Greek writers of the interpretation of things sacred and divine,
oracles, dreams etcill. Lk. 24:35) unto them all the things spoken to him by
the angel.
d. He sent them to Joppa (33miles).



II. GOD PREPARES PETER FOR HIS MISSION TO THE GENTILES.
A. God uses a vision to change Peters view of Gentiles. vs.9-16
1. It was about the sixth hour.
2. He became very hungry and would have eaten.
3. He fell into a trance (ekstasij -- a state in which the functions of the senses are
suspended and the soul seems to be liberated from the body whil it contemplates
some extraordinary object --- ill. Acts 11:5; 22:17):
a. He saw the heaven opened.
b. He saw a vessel like a great sheet. vs.12
* It had four corners.
* It was let down to the earth.
* It had four-footed beasts of the earth
* It had wild beasts.
* It had creeping things.
* It had fowls of the air.
c. A voice came to Peter saying:
* rise Peter
* kill and eat.

d. Peter refused the instructions given him. vs.14
* Peter said he had never eaten anything common. (Lev. 11:26-30)
* Peter said he had never eaten anything unclean.
e. The Lord explains to Peter why he should eat the things that he saw. vs.16
* God had cleansed (ekatqarizw to cleanse, purify) those things.
* They were no longer unclean.
f. The lowering of the sheet occurred repeatedly. vs.16
* It happened three times.
* It was received up into (the) heaven.

B. Cornelius men arrived as Peter contemplated the vision. vs.17-21
1. Peter was perplexed (dihporei to be completely at a loss what road to take by the
event. Joseph Thayer) ill. Lk. 24:4;Acts 5:24)
2. Cornelius men arrived.
a. They made inquiry for Simons house.
b. They stood before the gate.
c. Calling they inquired if Simon Peter lodged there.

3. Peter was yet pondering (dienqumoume,nou to think about, to think through and
through, in and out) the vision.
58
a. The Holy Spirit alerted him that three men sought him. vs.19
b. The Holy Spirit directed Peter to arise and go with the men doubting
nothing (diakrinomenoj -- pres.mid.part to separate, make distinction,
discriminate Joseph Thayer ill. Ja. 1:6). vs.20
c. Peter went down and introduced himself to the men. vs.21
4. Corneilus men explain the reason for their visit. vs.22
a. They explained the background of Cornelius to Peter:
* That he was a centurion.
* That he was a just (righteous) man.
* That he was one fearing the God (of Israel).
* That he had a testimony before all the nation of the Jews.

b. God sent an angel to warn (xrhmatizomai to instruct, to give a divine
warning to act upon a matter consistent with Gods plans -- ill. Heb. 11:7;
8:5) Corneilus to:
* Summon Peter to the house.
* To hear Peters words (rhmata utterances, individual parts of
doctrinehere concerning the Kingdom of God Acts 5:20,10:37;
13:42).
5. Peter responds with hospitality. vs.23
a. He lodged them.
b. He and other brethren accompanied them to Caesarea.
6. Cornelius gathered together his nearest relatives and intimate friends to hear what
Peter had to say. vs.24
7. Cornelius tried to worship (proseku,nhsen to kiss the feet of ill. Matt. 2:11; 1 Co.
14:25) Peter.
8. Peter rejects Cornelius worship signifying such worship is only given to deity. vs.26
a. Peter raised him up.
b. Peter admonished him that he too, was only a man.
9. Peter went in, talking with Cornelius and found many who had assembled. vs.27


C. Peter begins his message by emphasizing the unlawfulness of the presence of a Jew among
Gentiles.
1. Peter termed his entry among them as unlawful (a.qe, mito, n contrary to the
divinely constituted order of things, breaking a taboo Reinecker/Rogers)
a. It was unlawful for a Jew to come unto one of another nation (allofulw
of another tribe, one that is not a J ew. Not all intercourse with Gentiles was
absolutely prohibited, but that which rendered a J ew ceremonially unclean,
such as entering a Gentile house Reinecker/Rogers) (Acts 11:2-3; Gal.
2:11-12; John 4:9)
b. It was unlawful for a Jew to keep company (kollasqai adhere to; join
oneself to one as an associate Joseph Thayer) ill. Lk. 15;15



59


c. God graphically illustrated to Peter (in vision) to:
* Any man (anqropoj anarthorus any quality of man).
* Common (koinon --- to make Leviitically unclean, render
unhallowed, defile, profane Joseph Thayer) ill. Matt. 15:11, 18,20
* Unclean (a.ka, qarton to be unpure, soiled or stained by a thing)
ill. Heb. 9:13; Rom. 14:14,20

III. PETER IS GIVEN INSIGHT INTO GODS PLAN AND PURPOSES FOR MANKIND. vs.29-
33
A. Peters vision was the basis for why he traveled to see Corneilus. Vs.29
1. Therefore is used to indicate the reason he traveled to Caesarea.
2. Peter went without gainsaying (anantirrhtwj not speaking back, without
raising any objections Reinecker/Rogers) on account of the vision. ill. Acts 19:36

B. Cornelius gives Peter a thorough explanation for summoning him.
1. Cornelius recounted his vision four days before.
a. He was fasting until the ninth hour.
b. He saw a man (note the distinction from vs.3 an angel)
c. He recounted the message of the angel. vs.31-32
d. Cornelius wasted no time sending for Peter (at once). vs.33
e. He and his household were present to hear the things commanded thee
(prosta,sso to appoint before, define beforehand) of God. vs.33
ill. Acts 17:26

IV. Peter proceeds to teach Cornelius and his household the things he had put together from the
vision and what he had witnessed during Christs earthly ministry. vs. 34-43
A. Peter perceived (katalambanomai to grasp with the mind) that God is not a respecter
of persons (proswpolh, mpthj -- the fault of one who when called on to requite or to give
judgment has respect to the outward circumstances of men and not to their intrinsic
merits, and so prefers, as the more worthy, one who is rich, high-born, or powerful to
another who is destitute of such gifts Joseph Thayer). vs.34
1. Scripture has always maintained that God is not a respecter of person. Deut. 10:17
2. He did not choose Israel because of who they were. Deut. 7:6-7
3. He does not choose men today because of who they are. 1 Cor. 1:26-29
4. Believers today are told not to be a respecter of person. Ja. 2:1

B. Peter perceived that God has elect in every nation. vs.35

C. Peter perceived that this revelation was consistent with the message sent to Israel during
Christs earthly ministry. vs.36
1. The term word is ton logon (a discourse, message)
2. The Kingdom of God is a message of salvation for all men.
a. The Kingdom of God is generally seen in Scripture as emphasizing salvation
while the Kingdom of the Heavens is generally viewed as governmental rule.
60
i. Robert Saucy The Kingdom of God in Scripture is the all-
embracing program of Gods divine salvation history. All ages,
peoples, and saving activities are in some way related to it.
ii. Dwight Pentecost -- The name Kingdom of God is employed
because it points to the spiritual character of the reign and
dominion. The glory of God is its chief and sole object. Christs work
in which He seeks only to glorify His Father is complete when God is
glorified. This is the aim and purpose of the Kingdom of God.
b. Regeneration is necessary to enter into the Kingdom of God today. John 3:3
c. The Kingdom of God is invisible (Lk. 17:20-21).
3. The word was preached had two tenants:
a. Peace through Jesus Christ. (Lk. 2:13-14; 10:5)
b. He is Lord of all.

D. The Gentiles were familiar with this message that was preached. vs.37
1. Dr. Luke uses the word oidate (to know facts about something) for the word know.
2. That word is better translated (to genomenon rhma).
a. That word spread throughout all of Judea (its boundaries extended from
J oppa on the Mediterranean to a point on the J ordan about 10 miles n. of
the Dead Sea. Its s. boundary may be drawn from Wadi Ghazzeh, about 7
miles s.w. of Gaza, ghrough Beersheba, to the s. portion of the Dead Sea.
The length from north to south is about 55 miles, and from East to West the
same). D.N.T.T. (ill. Lk. 23:5; John 7:1)
b. It began to be preached in Galilee (it is about 60 miles long by 25 broad. It is
generally mountainous with fertile valleys between. The mixture of races
tended to produce a distinct accent or even dialect (Mk. 14:70; Lk. 22:59).
The people also was supposed to be one that never would produce a prophet
(J ohn 7:41, 52). Nevertheless, nearly all the apostles of J esus were natives
of Galilee, and he himself was brought up in it and made it the chief scene
of His ministry). D.N.T.T. (ill.)
c. It began being preached after the baptism that John preached. (ill. Mk. 1:14;
Acts 13:24)


E. The context of what the Gentiles knew about the word sent to Israel was: vs.38
1. Jesus of Nazareth was anointed:
a. With the Holy Spirit (ill. Lk. 4:18-19)
b. With power. (ill. John 3:2)

2. He went about doing good (euergetwn to do well, to do good; bestow benefits)
Acts 2:22
3. He went about curing all that were oppressed (katadunsteuomenouj to oppress, to
exploit, to dominate someone Reinecker/Rogers) by the Devil. (ill. Jas. 2:6)

F. The disciples were witnesses: vs.39a
1. They were witnesses of all the things that He did in the land of the Jews.
61
2. They were witnesses of all the things that He did in Jerusalem.

G. The Jews killed Him. vs. 39b

H. God raised Him up on the third day and showed Him openly. vs.40-41
1. The word shewed is (emfanh to manifest, exhibit, to view)
2. He didnt show Him to all the people (Israel)
3. He showed Him to chosen (prokeceirotonhmenoij to choose or designate by
hand, to choose beforehand) witnesses. ill. 1 Co. 15:1-8
4. He ate and drank with His disciples after His resurrection. (John 21:4-14)

J. Those witnesses were commanded to make proclamation to the people (Israel). vs.42-43
1. They were to teach that He was the One ordained (wrismenoj to mark out the
boundary, to ordain Reinecker/Rogers) of God:
a. He was ordained to be judge of the living. (2 Tim. 4:1; Matt. 25:31-46)
b. He was ordained to be judge of the dead. (Rev. 20:11-14)
2. They were to teach that He was the one testified of by the Prophets. vs.43
a. They testified that through His name would come forgiveness of sins.
(Matt.1: 21; Lk. 1:76-77)
b. They testified this forgiveness would come to those who believe in Him



V. CORNELIUS AND HIS HOUSEHOLD ARE SAVED. vs. 44-48
A. Another phase of the manifestation of the Holy Spirit occurred as Peter spoke to them. vs.44
1. The Holy Spirit had manifested Himself in two different ways prior to this
manifestation.
a. He came upon those on the Day of Pentecost as tongues like fire. Acts 2:3
b. He was given to those in Samaria as a result of the laying on of the hands
of the apostles. Acts 8: 14-16
2. The Holy Spirit fell on all those who heard Peters word (utterance).
3. Those of the circumcision (Acts 11:2) were astonished (exesthsan to be
besides oneself, to be amazed) that the Holy Spirit was poured out the Gentiles.
a. A sign of the Holy Spirits manifestation was that they spoke in tongues.
b. A sign of the Holy Spirits manifestation was that they magnified God.

B. Peter commanded that the Gentiles be water baptized due to their receiving the Holy Spirit.
vs. 47-48
1. Peter asserted that no man could (dunataiwas able) to forbid them from being
baptized. vs.47
a. They received the Spirit.
b. Their reception of the Spirit was as (wj similar, like) we.
2. Peter commanded them to be baptized in the name of Jesus Christ. vs.48
3. They asked him to tarry (epimeinai to remain) certain days.


62


CHAPTER 11
(41-51 a.d.)



I. PETERS ENTRY TO THE GENTILES CAUSED A GREAT COMMOTION AMONG THOSE
THE CIRCUMCISION.
A. News of the Gentiles salvation spread to Jerusalem. vs1
1. The apostles and the brethren that were in Judea heard the news.
2. The Word of God is the oral preaching of the apostles.

B. Those of the circumcision disputed with Peter over entering and eating with Gentiles. vs.2-3
1. The Circumcision was a term used Jews on account of the covenant of
circumcision. (ill. Gal. 2:7,8; Rom. 4:10; Phil. 3:1)
a. Some Jews adhered to the standards of circumcision instead of living by
Grace and caused a problems in Galatia, teaching the believer that
circumcision was a means of maturity. Gal. 5:6; 6:15
b. They disputed with Paul and Barnabas over whether the Gentiles should be
circumcised. Acts 15:1
2. The word disputed (diekrinouto to take issue, to dispute with someone
continuously Reinecker/Rogers)

C. Peter explained to the brethren why he was led to enter into the Gentiles. vs.4-18
1. Peter recounted how he saw a vision in Joppa. vs.4-5
a. The vision occurred while he was praying. vs.5
b. The vision occurred while he was in a trance.
c. The vision included a certain vessel that was similar to a great sheet let down
from heaven by four corners.
d. Peter gives two insights into his thinking at the time of the vision that was not
given in Chapter 10. vs.6
* He fastened (atenisaj -- to gaze) his eyes upon the sheet.
* He considered (katenooun -- to put the mind down, to understand,
to take notice of)
e. The things he fastened upon and considered were the various animals upon
the sheet.
2. Peter recounted how he heard a voice. vs.7-9
a. The voice told him to rise, slay and eat.
b. Peter was hesitant to obey the voice.
c. The voice informed him that he should not call common that which God has
cleansed.
3. Peter recounted how three men appeared at the house in which he was residing.
vs.11-12
a. The three men appeared already (ecauthj at once).
b. The Spirit bade (eipen said) him to go with them, doubting nothing.
63
vs.12a
c. Six brethren accompanied Peter as validation of the event. vs.12b
4. Peter recounted what he found when he reached Caesarea. vs.12c-13
a. Peter and the six (who were also of the circumcision Acts 10:23,45) who
accompanied him enter into the house of the man.
b. He (the man) showed Peter how he had seen an angel.
c. Peter relates some thing about Cornelius vision not mentioned by Cornelius
in his account:
*How the angel was standing and saying to him to send for Peter. vs.13b
*How the angel informed him how Peter would speak words whereby
which Cornelius and his whole household would be saved. vs.14
d. The Holy Spirit fell upon them.
* He fell upon them while Peter was speaking.
* He fell upon them as He did those at Pentecost.
i. as (wsper just as, like as) ill. Matt. 6:2
ii. on us (ef hmaj upon us)
iii. in a beginning (Acts 2:2)

5. Peter recounted how he connected the event to a prophecy made by the Lord during
His earthly ministry. vs.16
a. Peter said, I remembered (emnhsqhn to remember, recollect, call to
mindSheldon Green) Acts 1:5
b. The Word is better rendered the utterance
c. The Lord made a parenthetical statement, the second part of which was filled
in the Holy Spirits baptism in this Dispensation.
6. Peter gives a summation of his justification for going to the Gentiles. vs.17
a. God gave (didomi to bestow upon) them the equal gift as was given to
those believing upon the Lord, Jesus Christ.
(The term gave is used elsewhere in Scripture of God giving to ones
believe). 1 Co. 3:5
b. Peter didnt believe he was in a position to hinder God.


D. The ones out from the circumcision were content with Peters explanation. vs.18
1. They held their peace (hsuxasan ceased and desisted)
2. They glorified (edoxasan) (the) God saying:
a. God has granted to the nations repentance (th, n metanoian).
b. The repentance granted (didwmi) to them was unto life (eis zwhn into
this quality of life).



II. DR. LUKE SWITCHES SCENES FROM THE EVENTS SURROUNDING PETERS
ENTRANCE TO THE GENTILES TO THE ACTIVITIES OF THE REST OF THE CHURCH.
A. Luke explains the plight of those believers scattered as a result of Stephens persecution.
vs.19
64
1. The word scattered is the term diasparente which means to scatter abroad or in
every direction, as seed; to disperse Sheldon Green. (ill. 1 Pet. 1:1)
2. They traveled (dihlqon to go through or to pass through)
a. They traveled through Phoenica a narrow strip of territory between the
Mediterranean sea on the west and on the east the crest of the Lebanon
range and the detached hills running south from it. The area during the
time of the Lords earthly ministry included the cities of Tyre & Sidon.
Westminister Bible Dictionary.
b. They traveled through Cyprus an Island situated in the northeast part of
the Mediterranean Sea about 41 miles from the coast of Cilicia and 60
from Syria. Many J ewish communities existed in the island. Westminister
Bible Dictionary.
c. They traveled through Antioch a city founded in 300 b.c. by Seleucus
Nicator and named by him after Antiochus, his father. It was situated on
the south side of the Orontes river about 15 miles from its north. Its
population was mixed with not a few Jews. Westminister Bible
Dictionary.
3. They were preaching the word to no one except J ews only.
4. Some out from them were men of Cyprus and Cyrene (an important Greek
colonial city in North Africa. Cyrenians joined with the Libertines, or freedmen,
and other in forming a synagogue at Hersalem (Acts 6:9). J ews became resident
in Cyrene in the 3
rd
century b.c.). vs.20
a. They spoke unto the Grecians (Greek speaking Jews) in Antioch. vs.20a
b. They preached the Lord Jesus. vs.20b
5. The hand of the Lord was with them. vs.21a
6. A great number was saved. 21b
a. Believing --
b. They turned to the Lord.

B. News of the Gospel spread by those scattered reached Jerusalem. vs. 22
1. The Church heard the tidings (o logos)
2. Barnabas was selected to go as far (ewj up to the edge of) Antioch. Arriving:
a. He saw the Grace of God.
b. He rejoiced.
c. He exhorted (parekalei) all:
* He exhorted them with purpose from the heart.
* He exhorted them to cleave (prosmenein to continue, to remain, to
stay in a placeActs 18:18; 1 Ti.1: 3; 5:5) to the Lord.
3. Exhortation was natural for Barnabas. vs.24a
a. He was a good man.
b. He was full of the Holy Spirit.
c. He was full of faith
4. Many more were added to the Lord. vs.24b

C. Barnabas left Antioch for Tarsus in search of Saul. vs.25-26
1. Barnabas had to seek (anazhthsai- -- to search for; to seek up and down, back
65
and forth; to make a thorough search till success comes). Saul
2. He found Saul.
3. He brought him to Antioch.
4. They assembled in Antioch for a year with the Church there. vs. 26a
5. They taught much crowd. vs.26b
6. Antioch was the first place were disciples were called (Crhmatisai ---a lifestyle
reflected the standard of those where were anointed ones) Christians.
vs. 26c

D. Worldwide famine spurs giving from among believers. vs.27-30
1. Prophets went from Jerusalem to Antioch with the message. vs.27
2. Agabas was one of the prophets. vs.28a
3. Agabas signified (eshmainen to make know by a sign) by the Holy Spirit that
there would be a famine throughout the entire world. vs.28b
4. The famine occurred during the time of Claudius Caesar. 28c
5. The disciples determined (wrisan to fix a boundary, to determine, to appoint
they arranged. Perhaps each one set aside a fixed sum out of his property or
income as a contribution to the fund Reinecker/Rogers) to send relief to Judea.
vs.29
a. They determined to send aid according to (as measured by)
b. They determined to send aid according to his ability (euporeito to be well
off, to have plenty here according to financial ability Reinecker/Rogers)
6. They sent the offering by means of Barnabas and Saul. vs.30























66


CHAPTER 12
(A.D. 41-50)


I. HEROD JOINS THE JEWS IN PERSECUTING THE CHURCH.
A. Herod persecuted some in the Church. vs.1
1. The Herod mentioned here is Agrippa I who was the grandson of Herod the Great
(ruler during the birth of Christ Matt. 2:1) and the Father of Agrippa II before whom
the apostle Paul appeared. (Acts 26:1)
2. He stretched forth (e`pe,balen to cast upon, to lay hands on, to seize) his hands
(his authority, power).
3. He vexed (kakwsai to afflict, to do harm to Reinecker/Rogers) certain of the
Church.
a. He killed (a`nei/len to slay) James the brother of John with a sword (a
method of execution in the Roman empire -- ill. Rom. 13:4). vs.2
i. This fulfilled the prophecy the Lord Jesus made concerning James
(Mk. 10:35-40)
ii. One of only two apostles whose death or imminent death is recorded
in Scripture. (apostle Paul being the other 2 Tim. 4:7)
b. He proceeded (prose,qeto -- to add, join to, give in addition; of repeating
or continuing the action signified by the following verb Abbott & Smith)
further to take (arrest) Peter. vs.3a
c. Herod was motivated to take Peter because he saw that persecuting the
Christians pleased (a`resto,n pleasing, agreeableAbbott & Smith ill. 1
John 3:22) the Jews. vs.3b


B. Herod didnt immediately kill Peter as He did James because it was during days of
unleavened bread that he was apprehended. vs.4
1. The days of unleavened bread (Ex. 23:15; Deut. 16:16) is the Passover, the 1
st
of
the 3 annual festivals at which all the men were required to appear at the
sanctuary (Ex.12: 43; Deut. 16:1); It was instituted in Egypt to commemorate the
culminating event in the redemption of the Israelites; the day was to be
commemorated by a festival of 7 days duration (Ex. 12:14-20) Westminster
Dictionary of the Bible
2. He apprehended him.
3. He put him in prison.
4. He delivered him to four-quarternions (a company of four soldiers with four in
each group 16 in all) of soldiers to keep (fula,ssein -- to guard or watch
Abbott & Smith) him.
Note: The prison at J erusalem into which Herod Agrippa I cast Peter was
protected by iron gates, and important prisoners were bound with chains and
guarded by soldiers in the cell, while other soldiers kept watch before the
67
door. --Westminster Dictionary of the Bible (The cell in which Peter was kept
was an inner cell)

C. Herod intended (Boulomenoj determined) to use Peter to earn favor with the Jews. vs.5
1. He intended to bring him to the people (Israel).
2. He wanted to wait until after Easter (to. Pa,sca the Passover).



II. GOD RESCUES PETER FROM IMPRISONMENT.
A. The Church communicated on behalf of Peter.
1. Peter was therefore (on the one hand) kept in prison. vs.5a
a. The word therefore is the Greek idiom me. n which is used in this context to
point out the response of Gods people to a dire situation.
b. Peter was kept (e.threi/to being guarded) in prison.
2. The Church (on the other hand) prayed for him. vs.5b
a. The word but denotes the other half of the idiom.
b. In spite of the circumstances, the Church prayed for Peter.
i. The word prayer is proseuch. worship (ill. John 4:21-24)
ii. Prayer was without ceasing (e`ktenw/j fervently, earnestly Abbott
& Smith ill. Lk. 22:44)
c. There are three prepositions that describe the communications made for Peter.
i. The word of is the Greek word upo which means by (direct agent)
the Church.
ii. The word unto is the Greek word proj which means towards or
facing (the) God (Father).
iii. The word for is the Greek word peri which means generally
concerning (Peter).

B. God thwarts Herods plans to kill Peter. vs.6-10
1. Peter was held under tight security at the time Herod would have brought him
forth. vs.6
a. Peter was sleeping between two soldiers.
b. Peter was bound with two chains (presumably to each soldier).
c. Keepers (guards) before the door kept (guarded) the prison.
2. God sent an angel to set Peter free. vs7-10
a. The word the does not appear in the original. vs.7
b. The angel came upon (e`pe,sth --- to stand by Reinecker/Rogers)
c. A light shone (e;lamyen to shine;) in the building.
i. The angel smote (tata,xaj to strike or to hit Reinecker/Rogers)
Peter. (aor. part. he was striking Peter on the side)
ii. The angel raised (h;geiren to wake up Reinecker/Rogers) Peter.
iii. The angel urged Peter to rise in haste (ta,cei quickly)
d. Peters chains fell off his hands. vs.7
e. The angel urged Peter to gird (zw/sai to gird oneself, to bind the tunic
with a wide belt. During the night the long-flowing undergarment was
68
loosened, but fastened up by day, so as not to impede movements) himself.
vs.8a
f. The angel asked Peter to bind on (u`po,dhsai to bind under, to tie on
Reinecker/Rogers) his sandals. vs.8b
g. The angel asked Peter to cast (peribalou throw about oneself
Reinecker/Rogers) his garment ( possibly a cloak) and follow him. vs.8c
3. Peter did not know (h;dei he was continually unaware) vs.9
a. The thing happening through the angel was true.
b. He thought (e`do,kei to suppose, to think Reinecker/Rogers) that he had
seen a vision.
4. The angel led Peter out of the prison.
a. The angel led him through the first prison (cell).
b. The angel led him through the second prison (cell).
c. The angel led him upon the iron gate leading into the city.
i. The gate was opened to them.
ii. They went towards one street (a block).
iii. The angel departed.
5. Peter understood the significance of the event once he left the prison. vs.11
a. Peter was come to himself (genomenoj e`` n e`autw/ -- when he had become
present in himself; denoting his awaking from the dazed condition
produced by his being suddenly roused from sleep and confronted with a
supernatural appearance. Marvin Vincent)
b. The word now is an adverb of time
c. The Lord sent (exape,steilen--- to send out on a mission)
d. The Lord delivered (e`xei,lato, -- to remove above, to rescue
Reinecker/Rogers) Peter:
i. Out of the hand of Herod.
ii. Out of all the expectation of the people of the Jews (J ewish people).
6. Peter put together the events after he had left prison. vs.12
a. The word considered (sunidwn --- to view with mental discernment,
putting things together with claritythe fact that he had been freed; that
he was in the street alone; that he had to go somewhere; that Marys house
was a destination where he would find friends Marvin Vincent) the events.
b. Peter came to the house of Mary, the mother of John Mark
c. Many were gathered (sunhqroismenoi to bring together; to be gathered;
to meet.Reinecker/Rogers) ill. Lk. 24:33
d. They were praying (all night).
7. The believers were shocked by God s answer to their communication.vs.13-
a. Peter knocked at the door of the gate (the gate entrance of the house was
separated from the living quarters by a courtyard).
b. A damsel (paidi,skh a young female slave Abbott & Smith ill. Acts
16:16) who was named Rhoda hearkened (upakousaiaor. inf. to answer
the door. Used technically of the doorkeeper, whose duty it is to listen for
the signals of those who wish to enter, and to admit them if they are entitled
to do so Reinecker/Rogers)
i. She knew (e`pigno/usa --- to recognize) the voice of Peter. vs.15
69
ii. She opened not the gate for gladness.
iii. She ran in and told how Peter stood before the gate.
iv. The believers told her thou art mad. vs.15
v. Rhoda affirmed (diisxuri,zeto to insist; an old word of vigorous
and confident assertion) that it was so.
vi. The other believers thought, it was his angel (Heb. 1:13-14)
(Guardian angel, according to popular belief among the J ews that
every individual has his guardian angel, who may, on occasion,
assume a visible appearance resembling that of the person whose
destiny is committed to him. Marvin Vincent)
8. The believers finally opened the door to let Peter in. vs.16-17
a. Peter continued knocking.
b. They were astonished (e`xe,sthsan to be amazed, to be beside ones self)
when they opened the door.
c. Peter beckoning (katasei,saj to signal or motion with the hands
Reinecker/Rogers ill. Acts 21:40) them to be silent.
d. Peter declared (dihghsato ---to relate, narrate) to them how the Lord led
him out of the prison. ill. Lk. 8:39; 9:10
e. Peter said to them to report to James and the other brothers these things.
i. James, the Lords half brother was the leader of the Church at
Jerusalem. (Acts 21:17-18; Gal. 1:19)
ii. The bretheren other believers.
d. Peter went into another place.


III. HERODS ARROGANCE AND PERSECUTION OF CHRISTIANS LEADS TO DIVINE
JUDGMENT UPON HIM.
A. A disturbance arose among the guards over Peters disappearance. vs.18
1. The word small stir (ta,raxoj a commotion)
2. The term what was become is e`ge,neto what developed.

B. The disturbance over Peters disappearance occurred due to Herods summoning him.vs.19
1. Herod sought (e`pizhth,saj to look for) Peter.
2. Herod found him not.
3. Herod examined (a`nakri,naj examine, to question thoroughly) the guards.
4. Herod upon examination commanded they be put to death (a`pacqn/ai to lead
away to execution; a guard who allowed a prisoner to escape became liable to the
same penalty as had awaited the prisoner). ill. Acts 16:27; 27:42

C. Herod departed from Judea and went down into Ceasarea and abode (dietriben vs.20
1. Herod was displeased (qumomacw/n --- to fight desperately; to be furious; to be
exasperated Reinecker/Rogers) with the people of Tyre & Sidon.
2. The people of Tyre & Sidon asked peace with Herod because of they were
nourished (trefe,sqai to feed, to support, to provide with food. The Phoenician
cities depended largely on the grain fields of Galilee for their food and Herod had
cut off their supply) by his country.
70

D. Herod addressed the people of Tyre & Sidon. vs.21-22
1. A set day (taktoj set, appointed, According to J osephus, it was a festival in
honor of the emperor, possibly on the first of Aughus, the anniversary of his
birthday)
2. He was arrayed in royal (e`sqh,j clothing, raiment. A robe made of silver which
glittered in the sun Reinecker/Rogers ) clothing.
3. He was sitting upon his throne (bematoj ---
4. He made an oratation (e`dhmhgo,rie to speak in an assembly -- Reinecker/Rogers)
to them.
5. The people (dh/moj used to denote the common people) cried:
i. It is the voice of a God.
ii. It is not the voice of a man.

E. God rendered judgment upon Herod at that moment. vs.23
1. The word immediately denotes the swiftness of the judgment.
2. An angel from the Lord smote him because he didnt give glory to God.
3. Herod was eaten of worms (skw, lhkoBrwtoj --- to be eaten by worms the kind
which preys upon dead bodies; the word is used of diseased grain; it is used by
medical writers of intestinal worms).
4. He gave up the ghost (e`xe,fuxen to die, to breathe out)


F. The removal of Herod caused the Word of the Lord to continue to flourish. vs.24
1. The Word of God is used defined in Acts 8:12.
2. The Word of the Lord grew (huxanen --- was growing) after Herods death.
3. The Word of the Lord multiplied (eplhquneto increased, multipied)

G. Paul and Barnabas returned from their ministry to the saints suffering at Jersusalem and
took with them (sumparalaBo.ntej to take someone along) John Mark. vs.25
1. John Mark served as their attendant. Acts 13:5
2. He left them after problems in Pamhylia. Acts 13:13














71



Chapter 13
(A.D. 46-48)


I. THE HOLY SPIRIT SELECTS SAUL AND BARNABAS FOR THE WORK TO WHICH HE
CALLED THEM.
A. The Church at Antioch had ones with the spiritual gift of prophet and teacher. Acts 13:1
1. Baranabas
2. Simeon who was called Niger was possibley of African descent.
4. Lucius of Cyrene an important Greek colony in North Africa. Men of this area were
some of the early converts of the Church (Acts 11:20)
5. Manaen brought up (suntrofoj foster brother, intimate friend of) Herod the
tetrarch one who rules over the 4
th
part of a kingdom or province).
6. Saul

B. The Church at Antioch was the home base for Sauls apostolic journeys. vs.2-3
1.They ministered (leitourgou, rntwn used in classical Greek to describe the
service voluntarily rendered to the state. Later it indicated the performing of
services which the state required. Still later it was used to describe any kind of
service rendered in a temple. Reinecker/Rogers) at Antioch for approximately a
years time. vs.2 (Acts 11:26)
2. The Holy Spirit separated them for the work. vs.2
a. Separated (aforizw to mark off with a boundary, to separate).
b. The work (eij to ergon into the work)
c. I have called (proskeklhmai to call to ones service. The perfect
emphasizes that the divine decision was already made before it was revealed.
Reinecker/Rogers) ill. Acts 16:10; Ja. 5:14
3. The Church at Antioch authenticated Saul and Barnabas ministry: vs.3
a. Paul and Barnabas authentication was signified by their laying their hands
(Epiqentej -- to place upon. The laying on of hands here expressed the
fellowhip with the two and the recognition of the divine call
Reinecker/Rogers) on them. ill. Acts 8:17; 19:6; 1 Tim. 5:22
b. They sent (apoluw to release, to let go, to send off) them away.

C. Seleucia was the first stop on their first apostolic journey. vs.4

D. The sailed from Seleucia into Cyprus. vs.4
1. Salamis was a city on the island of Cyprus. vs.5
a. They preached the Word of God in the synagogues of the Jews.
i. The Word of God was the oral preaching by the apostles of the
entrance into the Kingdom of God by believing in the name of Jesus
Christ. (ill. Acts 8:12,14; 10:34-42; 11:1; 13:35-43)
b. John Mark served as their minister (uphre, thj assistant, attendant, a
72
helper who willing submits himself to the carrying out of the will of the one
over him. Reinecker/Rogers) ill. 1 Co. 4:1; Acts 26:16
2. Paphos was a city situated on the southwest side of the island of Cyprus. vs.6
a. Saul and Barnabas went through (dielqontoj to pass through no other
stops) Cyprus into Paphos.
b. They came upon a guy named Bar-jesus.
i. He was a sorcerer (magon magician)
ii. He was a false prophet one who made false prophecies.
iii. He was a Jew.
c. Bar-jesus was with the deputy, Sergius Paulus. vs.7
i. With is the Greek proposition sun intimately with him maybe
chief assistant.
ii. A deputy was call an anqupatoj or proconsul, one who is head of
the government in a senatorial province.
d. Sergius Paulus was a prudent (sunetw sensible, acute, judicious
characterized by sound judgment; penetrating consideration peceding
decision and action; the understanding of the matter in hand) man. vs.7
ill. 2 Tim. 2:7
i. He called for Barnabas and Saul.
ii. He desired (epezhthsen to seek, to look for; to diligently pursue
for the purpose of finding ill. Rom. 11:7; Matt. 6:32). to hear the
Word of God.
e. Elymas (Bar-Jesus) the sorcerer withstood them vs.8
i. Elymas means sorcerer.
ii. The term withstood is used throughout Scripture of those mature
sons opposition to the things of God. (ill. 2 Tim. 3:8)
iii. The purpose of Elymas withstanding them was to seek to turn away
Sergios Paulus away from The Faith vs.8
* The term turn away is diastefai to twist or to pervert (Acts
20:30)
* The term turn away is a purpose infinitive which indicates
the purpose as to why Elymas withstood Paul and Barnabas.
iv. Saul reacts to Elymas attempts to undermine his ministry to Sergios
Paulus. vs.9
* He was filled (plhsqeij complete mental filling) with the
Holy Spirit.
* He set (gazed upon) his eyes upon him.
v. Saul identifies the power energizes Elymas vs.10
* He identified him as being full of all subtilty (deceit,
treachery. Properly bait for fish, then any cunning
contrivance for deceiving or catching Reinecker/Rogers).
ill. Rom. 1:29; 2 Co. 4:2
* He identified him as being a child (uie. son) of the devil.
* He identified him has being an enemy of all righteousness.
* He identified his relentlessness in not ceasing to pervert the
right ways of the Lord.
73
vi. Elymas receives judgment for his behavior. vs.11
* The Hand of the Lord is upon thee
* Thou shalt be blind not seeing the sun for a season
* A mist (a`clu.j cloud; used by medical writers of an
inflammation which brings a cloudy appearance into the eye)
and a darkness fell upon him.
* He went about seeking (the imperfect of zhtew denotes that
he was looking searching around, but doesnt say whether he
found someone ill. Acts 9:8) to lead him by the hand.
vii. Sergios Paulus was impacted by the things that happened to Elymas.
* He believed when he saw (i`dw.n-- seeing) what was done.
* He was being astonished (e`kplh, ssomenoj -- to strike one
out
of self-possession, to strike with panic, shock, astonish
Joseph Thayer -- ill. Matt. 7:28; 22:33) at the doctrine of the
Lord.

E. Paul, Barnabas and company leaves Paphos and travel to Perga in Pamphylia. vs.13
1. Pamphylia was a stretch of coastland in Asia Minor.
2. Perga was a town in Pamphylia.
3. The term company (oi, peri. the ones concerning an idiom used to denote
certain ones bound together for a particular purpose Jude 7; Matt. 20:9; Mk.
4:10)
4. They were loosed (to set sail) from Paphos.
5. John departing from them returned into Jerusalem (where they met him Acts
12:25)
a. The word departing is a`pocwrh, saj to depart, to leave, to desert
Reinecker/Rogers) ill. Acts 15:39
b. Paul thought him useful later in his ministry. 2 Tim. 4:11
F. Paul and company departed from Perga and went into Antioch in Pisidia. vs.14
1. They went into the synagogue on the Sabbath day and sat down.
a. Entering the Jewish synagogue was a habit of Pauls in his first two apostolic
journeys. Acts 13:14; 14:1; 17; 1-2, 10,17
b. The order of service of in the synagogue was: (Reineker/Rogers)
i. The Shema (Hear O Israel the Lord our God is one God)
ii. Prayer by the Leader.
iii. Reading of the Law (ill. Lk. 4:16-21)
iv. A sermon by a member of the congregation. (ill. Acts 13:15)
2. The ruler of the synagogue sent unto them after the reading of the law
and the prophets. (it was his job to select the speaker for the service) vs.15a
3. The leaders asked them if they had any word of exhortation for the
people. vs. 15b
a. The term exhortation is paraklh, sewj with logos (word) denotes a
persuasive discourse, stirring address, instructive, admonitory,
consolatory; powerful hortatory discourse. ill.1 Thess. 2:3
b. The term the people is (the Jews).
74




II. PAUL RESPONDED TO THE LEADERS INVITATION WITH A HISTORICAL
NARRATIVE OF GODS DEALINGS WITH ISRAEL FROM THE TIME OF ABRAHAM TO
THEIR REJECTION OF CHRIST AND HIS SUBSEQUENT TURNING TO THE GENTILES.
A. Paul rose to the occasion of addressing the audience. vs.16
1. Paul stood up
2. Paul beckoning with the hand he addressed the audience.
3. Paul addressed two different groups that was in the synagogue:
a. Men of Israel --
b. Ye that Fear God (Jewish proselytes see vs.26, 43)
c. The term give audience means listen.

B. Paul gives a historical narrative of Israel that connects the promise made to Abraham
to Jesus. vs.17-25
1. The God of Israel chose (eklegw in the middle voice meaning to choose for
Himself) our Fathers. vs.17 (ill. Deut. 4:32-37; 10:14-15)
2. He exalted them when they dwelt as strangers in the land of Egypt. vs.17a
a. The term exalted is u`fo, w to lift up on high. (ill. Acts 7:10)
b. Strangers is paroikia soujourn, living in a place as a stranger or
foreigner. ill. 1 Pet. 2:11
3. He brought them out of Egypt with a high arm (Braxiwn with might and power
Joseph Thayer -- ill. Lk. 1:51; John 7:38). 17a (Deut. 9:26-29)
4. He suffered their manners in the wilderness about the time of forty years. vs.
18
a. Suffered is the Greek word e`tropofo, rhsen to bear or put up with
someone, endure. (1 Co. 10:1-6; Num. 14:25-34)
b. Manners is actually the personal pronoun autou them.
5. He destroyed seven nations in the land of Cannan and divided their land to them by
lot. vs.19
a. Destroyed is the Greek word kaqelwn to take down; cast down. (ill. Lk.
1:52)
b. The seven nations destroyed were the Canaanites, Amorites, Hittites,
Perizzites, Hivites, and the Jebusites and the Girgashites. (Deut. 7:1)
b. He divided by lot (kateklhronomhsen to divide according to lots, to
distribute an inheritance, to take for a possession, to give for a possession
Reinecker/Rogers) their land to Israel. Joshua Chapter 14

6. He gave to them judges. vs.20
a. After that (rather after these things).
b. He gave the judges (kritaj one who passes or arrogates to himself,
judgment on anythingJoseph Thayer. Judges 2:11-17
c. Judges judged Israel for about 450 years (until ewj up to the edge of
Samuel).
75
d. Samuel introduced the time of the prophets.
7. Israel desired a king. vs.21-22
a. Aitew is the word used which for desired which means to ask for ones
self. (1 Samuel Chapter 8)
b. God gave them Saul the son of Kish of the Tribe of Benjamin. (1 Samuel.
Chapter 9)
b. Saul ruled Israel for about 40 years. (1 Samuel 10-16)
c. God removed Saul. vs.22a (1 Sam. 15:1-28)
d. God raised up (e`gei, rw to raise upto cause to appear, bring before the
public. Joseph Thayer) unto them David to be their king. vs.22b
e. He gave testimony (witness) to David:
i. David was a man after Gods own heart.
* After is the Greek preposition kata according to, measured
by.
* The term heart here denotes desires, will.
ii. David would fulfil (poihsei to do or to make) all my will (qelhmata
the things desired)
iii. God removed Saul because he was self-willed. He did not desire to do
Gods will, but his own. (ill. 1 Sam. 15:17-24); David was seen as a
man after Gods own heart because he generally desired to do Gods
will in spite of his flaws.
8. God raised a Savior to Israel out from Davids seed. vs.23 (2 Sam. 7:11-13; Lk. 1:68-
74)
a. The term seed (spermatoj offspring, progeny, family, race, prosterity
that which is derived from the male to propagate the family line)
emphasizes physical lineage. (ill. Matt. 1:6; 15; 22; Mk. 10:46-48)
b. God raised Him according to his promise (Gen. 22:18)
c. God raised a Savior to Israel. vs.23
i. Christ was born to be Savior of Israel in a physical sense. Lk. 1; 68-74
ii. Christ was born to be Savior of Israel in a spiritual sense. (ill. Lk.
2:11; Matt. 1:21)
9. John the Baptist introduced Jesus to the Nation Israel. vs.24-25
a. The word when denotes the time that the Savior was presented to Israel.
b. John preached (prokhru, xantoj to proclaim beforehand):
i. He preached a baptism of repentance. Matt. 3:11
ii. He preached to all the Nation Israel. John 1:31
10. John acknowledged that he was not the one Israel was awaiting. vs.25
a. John acknowledged it when he fulfilled (e`plh, rou filled up what was
lacking of) his course.
b. John questioned others concerning their view of him. John 1:19-26
c. John acknowledged that he wasnt worthy of latching the sandals of Jesus.
John 1:27
C. Paul noted that the salvation promised to the Nation Israel was now been made available to
all men. vs.26
1. Its sent to men.
2. Its sent to brethren.
76
3. Its sent to children of the stock of Abraham.
4. Its sent to whosoever among you feareth God.
5. The word concerning this salvation (Acts 10:34-40) sent to you.

D. The apostle Paul recounts Israels rejection of Christ. vs.27a
1. Paul recounts that They that dwell at Jerusalem rejected Him.
2. Paul recounts that Their rulers rejected Him.

E. Paul recounts why they rejected Christ. vs. 27b-28a
1. They knew (a`gnoh,santej to be ignorant, not to recognize) him not. (ill. Rom.
10:3)
2. They knew not touton (this thingGods plan for their salvation?)
3. They knew not the voices of the prophets (which are read every Sabbath day)

F. Paul gives two indictments against those accused of killing Jesus. vs.28b
1. They condemned Him, fulfilling Scripture. (ill. Matt. 26:65-66)
2. They desired Pilate that He should be slain (a`naire,w to put out of the way, to
slayJoseph Thayer ill. Matt.2:16).
3. They desired this of Pilate even though they found no cause (a`iti,a
charge, reason for a capital punishment) of death in Him. (ill. John 19:6-16)

G. The apostle Paul reminded the Jews that God allowed the things that happened to the Lord.
vs.29-31
1. The things the rulers did fulfilled (completed) all that was written of Christ. vs.29a
2. They took Him down from the tree, and laid Him in a sepulcher. vs.29b
3. God raised him from the dead (nekrw/n-- to be destitute of life, with out life,
inainimate Joseph Thayer) out from among . vs.30
i. He was seen many days of them which came up with him from Galilee to
Jerusalem. (Lk. 24:19-31; 1 Co. 15:5-8)
ii. Those who saw him are (His) witnesses unto the people (Israel).

H. God fulfilled the promise made to the fathers. vs.32
1. Paul declared unto the Jews the promise (A savior -- vs.23)
2. Paul declared the glad tidings

J. God fulfilled the promise unto the children of the fathers.
1. The promise was fulfilled in that He raised Jesus again. vs.33
2. The resurrection of Jesus was prophesied. vs. 33 (Ps. 2:7)
3. David also spoke of the resurrection of Jesus. vs.34-37

K. Paul exhorts the Jews that Jesus life prove that He was the fulfillment of the promise made
to the fathers. vs.38-39
1. Through Him was preached unto you forgiveness of sins. vs.38 (Acts 5:31)
2. All that believe are justified from all things:
a. Which they could not (hdunh,Qhte were not able; did not have the ability)
b. Be justified (dikaiwQhnai to justify, to declare righteous) by the law of
77
Moses. vs. 39 ill. Heb. 7:19; Rom. 3:21-26

L. Paul warns the Jews of rejecting the good news about Jesus. vs.40
1. The term beware is the Greek word blepete to glance at.
2. Rejection could lead them to the prophecy made about the prophets. (Hab. 1:5)
a. Despisers (katafronhthj one who despises, one who thinks down on
another Reinecker/Rogers ill. Matt. 6:24; 18:10)
b. Wonder (Qaumasate to be amazed) and perish (a,fani,sqhte
emphasizes to vanish away, to destroy utterly so as to be invisible
Reinecker/Rogers).
c. I will work a work in your days.
d. Ye shall not believe though one tells you in detail (ekdihgh/tai to declare,
to relate in detail).


III. PAULS MESSAGE PEAKED THE INTEREST OF SOME JEWS AND THE GENTILES.
vs.42-49
A. The Gentiles besought that the words Paul spake might be preached to them on the next
Sabbath. vs.42
1. The Gentiles besought (parakalew to ask, to beseech, -- inceptive impf. they
began to beseechReinecker/Rogers)
2. The Gentiles besought them as they were gone out of the synagogue.

B. Two groups of people were intent on hearing more after the congregation was broken up:
vs.43a
1. Many (belonging to) the Jews.
2. Many Religious proselytes (sebomenwn proshlutwn men dededicated in service
to God who had converted over to J udism).

C. The two groups followed (hkolou, qhsan -- they were made to follow i.e. because of
their message; possibly the Holy Spirit drew them to Paul and Barnabas) Paul and
Barnabas. 43b
1. Speaking to them,
2. They persuaded (e, piei/qon to persuade, urged) them to continue in the Grace of
God.
3. To remain (epimenein to remain, to abide; to stay with; continue in) purpose
infinitive.

D. The whole city (Antioch) came to hear the word of God the next Sabbath. vs.44
1. Almost scedo,n -- in some languages is 'all the people in the town came, but
some did not' or 'only a few of the people in town didn't come.
2. The word came is suna, gw (pass. voice) means they were brought (probably as a
result of the good news)
3. The phrase to hear is an infinitive of purpose which denotes the sole reason why
they came.

78
E. The Jews responded with disdain to the multitudes. vs.45
1. They were filled with envy
2. They spake against (a|t.,. -- to speak against, gainsay, contradict;
absolutelyJoseph Thayer) ill. Acts 28:19,22; Tit. 1:9; 2:9 those things which were
spoken by Paul:
a. They spake against them by contradicting.
b. They spake against them by blaspheming.

F. The Jews response to Paul and Barnabas results in a turning point in their ministry toward
the Jews. vs.46
1. It was necessary (a|a,sate,, -- necessary; what one cannot do without,
indispensable Joseph Thayer) that the word of God should first have been spoken
to you. 2 Co. 9:5; Phil. 1:24
2. First is prowton -- either in time or place, in any succession of things or of
persons. Rom. 1:16; 2:9,10
3. Seeing (Epeidh. --markers of cause or reason, often with the implication of a
relevant temporal element - 'because, since, for, inasmuch as Louw Nida 1 Co.
15:21) that you put it from you.
4. You put it from you (a, pwqei/sqe -- to use force in pushing or thrusting someone
or something away or aside - 'to push away, to thrust aside Louw- Nida) Acts
7:27, 39; Rom. 11:1,2
5. Judged yourselves (reflexive pronoun emphasizes that their rejection stand in
judgment of the fact) unworthy of everlasting life (eternal.
6. We turn to the Gentiles.

G. Reaching the Gentiles was prophesied in the O.T. vs.47 (Lk. 2:32;

Isaiah 40:17;

Isaiah
42:6; Isaiah 49:6)
1. I have set thee to be a light to the Gentiles. Lk. 2:32
2. Thou shouldest be for salvation unto the ends of the earth. Lk. 2:32

H. The Gentiles responded to the message with joy. vs.48
1. They were glad (e,at . -- to enjoy a state of happiness and well-being - Acts
11:23; 15:23)
2. They glorified (edoxa ,e| -- to speak of something as being unusually fine and
deserving honor Louw-Nida) the Word (from) the Lord.
3. Those ordained to eternal life believed.
a. The term believed is e:tc.u . -- to believe something to be true and,
hence, worthy of being trusted - 'to believe, to think to be true, to regard as
trustworthy. Louw-Nida ill. Acts 4:4; 5:14; 8:12; 15:7; 16:31; 19:5
b. As many as is an adverb (osoi --pertaining to a comparative quantity of
objects or events - as many as, as much as) which limits who believed.
c. Ordained (pres. pass. part.) .a,. |et -- to assign someone to a
particular task, function, or role - 'to appoint, to designate, to assign, to
give a task to. ill. Acts 22:10; 28:23; Rom. 13:1

79
I. The Word of the Lord was published (diaferw to carry through Reinecker/Rogers)
throughout the region. vs.49

J. Pauls message peaked the anger of the Jews. vs.50 a
1. The Jews stirred up (tarwtrunan --to stir up hostility against - 'to stir up, to incite
to -- hapox) others against Paul and Barnabas.
2. They stirred up the devout and honorable (.uc, e|ac -- pertaining to having an
attractive form - 'attractive, presentable) women
3. They stirred up the chief men of the city.
4. They raised persecution against Paul and Barnabas. vs.50 b
5. They expelled them out of their coasts (.ete| --region or regions of the earth,
normally in relation to some ethnic group or geographical center, but not
necessarily constituting a unit of governmental administration - 'region, territory,
land' (and even district, though this might imply too precisely a governmental
area). vs.50 c

K. Paul and Barnabas responded allow the Jews to oppose themselves.
1. They shook of the dust of their feet against them. vs.51a (ill. Matt. 10:14)
2. They left and came unto Iconium. vs.51b

L. The disciples responded the way they did due to being filled by the Holy Spirit. vs.52
1. They were filled with joy. vs. 52a
2. They were filled with the Holy Spirit. vs.52b























80



Chapter 14
(A.D. 46-48)



I. PAUL AND BARNABAS COLLIDED WITH HEATHENISTIC RELIGIONS IN ICONIUM.
A. Paul reaches both Jews and Greeks in Iconium.
1. Paul begins as had become his custom, in the Jewish synagogue. vs.1
2. A great multitude believed from the Jews and Greeks.

B. The unbelieving Jews were unhappy with the response to Paul & Barnabas message.vs.2
1. They stirred up (to awaken, rouse up-Pass. to be roused, wake up, --
Liddell& Scott ill. Acts 13:50) the Gentiles.
2. They made their minds evil affected (ekakosanto make evil, injure, to irritate)
against the brethren.

C. Paul and Barnabas were undeterred by the commotion caused over them. vs.3
1. They abode a long time in Inconium.
2. They spoke bodly (to be confident, unrestrained in the face of adversity ill. 1
Thess. 2:2; Eph. 6:20) in the Lord
a. They gave testimony unto the word of (concerning) His grace.
b. Signs and wonders were granted to be done by their hands. (ill. Heb. 2:1-4)

D. The Jews subversion of Paul and Barnabas eventually caused a divide (esci,sQh a split
or a tear ill. John 19:24 (physical); Acts 23:7 (metaphorical)) among the people of
Iconium. vs. 4
1. Part held (sun were intimately together with) the Jews.
2. Part held (sun were intimately together with) the apostles.
3. The Gentiles, the Jews and their rulers made an assault against the apostles. vs.5
a. They tried to use them despitefully (to mistreat, to treat shamefully, it
expresses insulting and outrageous treatment which is calculated publicly
to insult and openly to humiliate a person Reinecker/Rogers. Ill. 1 Thess.
2:2; Acts 16:16-24
b. They tried to stone them.
4. Paul and Barnabas fled when they were ware (sunido, ntej to have intimate
knowledge) of the plot. vs.6
a. They fled into Lystra & Derbe, cities of Lycaonia.
b. They preached (per. act. of euaggelw to proclaim) the gospel there. vs.7


E. A disturbance arises among the people of Lycaonia when Paul and Barnabas refused
worship over their healing of an impotent man.
1. The impotent man was of Lystra descent. vs.8
81
a. He was impotent (adu, natojwithout ability, strength Joseph Thayer) in
his feet.
b. He was cripple from his mothers womb.
c. He had never walked.
2. The impotent man responded to the message of the apostles. vs.9-10
3. Paul began interacting with the man:
a. He steadfastly beheld (to gaze upon intently) him. ill. Acts 1:10; 3:12;
6:15; 13:19
b. He perceived (idwn --to see with discernment of thought) ill. Acts 8:23;
11:23;13:21 that he had faith to be healed.
c. He instructed the man to stand upright on his feet.

F. The people of Lystra response to the healing was to offer worship to Paul and Barnabas.
vs.11
1. They lifted up their voices the Lyconian speech (the speech of the natives of the land
as opposed to the Romans or military officials who were affluent in the Greek
language) the gods have come down in the likeness of men.
a. Hermes was considered the god of eloquence; the attendant, messenger and
spokesman of the gods. (I.S.B.E.)
b. Zeus was attributed to Barnabas because of his commanding presence.
2. The Lyconian worship of these deities included sacrifices. vs.13



II. PAUL OFFERS THE GENTILES A HISTORICAL NARRATIVE OF THEIR DEALINGS
WITH THE TRUE GOD.
A. Paul and Barnabas were appalled over their attempts to worship them. vs.14
1. They rent (diarrh, xantej in New Testament the tearing of clothes was a symbol
of horror associated with sacriledge Louw-Nida) their clothes. Ill. Matt. 26:65;
Mk. 14:63
2. They ran in among the people in an attempt to dissuade them.

B. Paul made two points in his attempt to dissuade their worship of he and Barnabas. vs.15
1. They were like passion (having similar desires and feelingsPaul
tries to lead these away from worshipping men to worshipping the true God) as the
Lyconians.
2. Their message was for the Lyconians to turn from these vanities (pointless things
ill. Eph. 4:17) to the true God.
a. He made heaven
b. He made earth.
c. He made the sea all things that are therein.

C. Paul offers justification for why the Lyconians may not have been familiar with the true
God. vs. 16-17
1. He allowed all nations Gentiles to walk in their own ways in times past.
a. The term allowed means to allow someone to do something, to let,
82
permitLouw-Nida).
b. Walk is the Greek term poreu, esQai to go on a journey with a purpose in
mind) ill. Acts 18:6; 19:21; 20:1
c. The time frame in which God allowed them to walk in their own ways was in
(the) generations past (parwxhmenaij to be gone by, past emphasis is on
the passage of time). ill. Eph. 2:11-13; Rom. 11:25-30
2. He gave them a witness by doing good
a. He gave them rain from heaven.
b. He gave them fruitful seasons.
c. He filled the Gentiles hearts with food and gladness.



III. THE GENTILES OF LYSTRA REJECT PAULS MESSAGE.
A. They restrained them (caused them to rest -- barely) from offering sacrifice to them. vs.18

B. Jews from Antioch and Iconium, however, persuaded the people. vs.19
1. They stoned (to kill or attempt to kill by means of hurling stones,
normally carried out by angry mobs - 'to stone to death Louw-Nida)
Paul.
2. They drew (dragged by force ill. Acts 8:3; Rev. 12:4) him out of the city
supposing (drawing a conclusion about a matter based upon available
informationill. Acts 7:25; 8:20; 16:27; 17:29) he had been dead.

C. Paul rose up as the disciples stood round (to surround, encircle, encompass Joseph
Thayer aor. act. part. ill. John 10:24; Heb. 11:30) about him.
1. He went into the city.
2. The next day he departed with Barnabas to Derbe.



IV. PAUL AND BARNABAS TAUGHT AT DERBE BEFORE DOUBLING BACK AND
RETRACING CITIES WHERE THEY ESTABLISHED CHURCHES ON THE FIRST
JOURNEY.
A. They preached the gospel in Derbe. vs.20

B. They taught (were discipling) many.

C. They returned again to Lystra, Iconium and Antioch.

D. Paul and Barnabas engaged in four things when revisiting Lystra, Iconium and Antioch.
vs.22-23
1. They confirming the souls (episth,rizwn establishing, causing one to be able to
stand firm) of the disciples. (ill. 15:32; 41; 18:23)
2. They exhorted them to continue in the faith.
3. They reminded them that it was necessary that the entrance into the Kingdom of God
83
was through much tribulation.
4. They ordained elders in every church.
a. They prayed with fasting.
b. They commended them to the Lord.

C. Paul and Barnabas preached the word in Perga. vs. 24-25

D. Paul and Barnabas returned to Antioch where they had began their apostolic journey. vs.26
1. It was the place where they had been recommended to the grace of God for the
work
2. The apostles fulfilled all that was laid out for them to complete.

E. Paul and Barnabas discussed their journey with the church at Antioch. vs.27
1. They gathered the church together.
2. They rehearsed:
a. All that God had done with them.
b. How God had opened the door of faith unto the Gentiles.

F. They spent a considerable amount of time in Antioch. vs. 28



























84



Chapter 15
(A.D.51-54)


I. A QUESTION AROSE FOLLOWING PAULS FIRST APOSTOLIC JOURNEY AS TO
WHETHER THE GENTILES SHOULD OBSERVE THE MOSAIC LAW. Acts 15:1-21
A. Judiazers taught the brethren in Antioch that it was necessary for the Gentiles to be
Circumcised after the customs of Moses. vs.1
1. The term from Judea is used elsewhere in Acts to denote those coming from the
the region of Jerusalem. (ill. Acts 12:10; 28:21)
2. They were continually teaching as doctrine to be practiced (edida,skon).
3. The customs (eqoj --a pattern of behavior more or less fixed by tradition and
generally sanctioned by the society - 'custom, habit ill. Heb.10:25) of Moses.
(Acts 21:21; 28:17)
4. The phrase ye cannot be saved is used elsewhere in Scripture with reference to
initial salvation. Matt. 19:25; Acts 4:12; 14:9; 2 Thes. 2:10; 1 Tim. 2:4

B. Two words are used to describe the uproar that developed over the assertion that the
Gentiles should be under law. vs. 2a
1. The term dissension is stasews which means to rise up in open defiance of
authority, with the presumed intention to overthrow it or to act in complete
opposition to its demands - 'to rebel against, to revolt, to engage in
insurrection, rebellion. (Acts 19:40:23:10)
2. The second word used is a form of zeteo which is a debate.

C. Paul, Barnabas and others apostles and elders from Antioch determined to go up to
Jerusalem concerning the debate. vs.2b

D. The group headed for Jerusalem on the one hand, was focused on spreading the news about
the Gentiles. vs.3
1. They were officially brought on their way (to send someone on in the
direction in which he has already been moving, with the probable
implication of providing help - 'to send on one's way, to help on one's way)
sent forth to Jerusalem by the church at Antioch.vs.3a
2. They declared the conversion of the Gentiles to the brethren in Phoenicia and
Samaria. vs.3b
3. The news of the conversion of the Gentiles brought great joy to the brethren.
vs.3c

E. On the other hand, the group head to Jerusalem were singularly focused on resolving the
question of whether the Gentiles had to observe the customs of Moses. vs.4
1. The group was welcomed by the apostles and elders upon their arrival. vs.4
2. Paul and Barnabas gave the church at Jerusalem an accounting of their first apostolic
85
journey. vs.4

F. Some of the believing Pharisees believed the Gentiles should be under law. vs.5
1. Certain ones from (out of) the sect of the believing Pharisees rose up to voice
their opinion over the direction of the Gentiles. vs. 5a
2. Needful is the Greek word Dei which is a logical necessity (ill. Matt. 16:21; Lk.
24:44; John 3:7)
a. They thought that it was necessary they be circumcised. vs.5b
b. They thought that it was necessary they keep (obey Acts 21:25). 5b

G. The apostles and the elders gathered to consider the matter. vs.6-7
1. The issue brought together the apostles and the elders to consider (I,dei/n to view
with mental discernment of thought)
2. The term matter goes back to the saying in verse 5. vs. 6
3. A considerable amount of disputing (debating) developed over the topic. vs.7a

H. Peter rose to bring perspective to the debate by telling what God led him to do. vs.7b
1. Peter began with what all assembled understand (e,pi,stasqe --to possess
information about, with the implication of an understanding of the
significance of such information) ill. Acts 10:28; 19:25
2. They all understood that God had chosen Peter to go to the Gentiles. vs.7b
a. God chose in ancient days that through the mouth of Peter the Gentiles
would hear the word of the gospel.
b. God chose in ancient days that through mouth of Peter the Gentiles
would believe the word they heard.

G. Peter established that God made no distinction any longer between the Jew and the
Gentile. vs.8-9
1. He bare them witness (testified of them) by giving to them (for their advantage)
the Holy Spirit just as he did to those at Pentecost. vs.8
2. God put no difference (he didnt make a distinction) between the Jews and the
Gentiles. vs.9
a. God purified their hearts. (ill. 2Pet. 1:9; Tit. 2:14)
b. The instrument of their hearts being purified is by the faith.

H. Peter warned the Jews not to put a yoke on the Gentiles. vs.10
1. The term now therefore brings Peters point to a summation.
2. Peter warned that putting the Gentiles under the customs of Moses would be
tempting God. (putting God to the test -- ill 1 Co. 10:9)
3. Peter warned that putting the Gentiles under the customs of Moses would be a yoke
upon their necks.
4. Peter warned that neither the current Jews nor their fathers could bear (bastasai
to carry a load; a heavy or burdensome object) the customs of Moses.

I. Peter established that the Gentiles in this dispensation are saved as are the Jews. vs.11-12a
1. The word but (on the contrary) is contrasted to the customs of Moses.
86
2. It is through Grace (generally concerning) the Lord Jesus (Peter and others there)
were saved (initially) just as the Gentiles are saved.
3. Peters addressed silenced the crowd. vs.12a
J. Paul and Barnabas chimed in with their account of how the Lord used them among the
Gentiles. vs.12b
1. They declared (to draw out in narrative, unfold in teaching; a. to recount,
rehearse) Lk. 24:35
2. They declared how God had done signs in among the Gentiles.
3. They declared how God had done miracles in among the Gentiles.

K. The Judiazers remained upon hearing the reports. vs.13

L. James (the brother of Jesus) connected the reports to Old Testament prophecy.
1. Peters account was in accord (sumfwnh,swsin joined together with ill. Matt.
18:19) with prophecy concerning the Gentiles. vs.14-15
a. God foretold that he would visit the Gentiles. (Deut. 14:2)
b. God foretold that he would take out from the Gentiles a people for his name
(character) ill. Tit.2:14
2. God prophesied that He would return. (Amos 9:11 Note: there is a difference of
quotation in Amos than in Acts the difference being in that day verses after
these things (The difference in quotation is the difference between the actual and the
potential in Gods decree)
3. God prophesied that he would build the tabernacle of David. 2 Sam. 7:16-17; Lk.
1:32-33
4. God prophesied that setting up the tabernacle of David would cause the residue of
men perhaps might seek after the Lord.
5. God knew that this would happen from the (ages). vs.18

M. James proposed an answer as to how to handle the Gentiles.
1. Wherefore (because of the information provided by Peter, Paul and Barnabas).
2. James proposed that they be not troubled (to cause extra difficulty and hardship
by continual annoyance Louw-Nida). Vs. 19
3. James proposed that they be given four instructions. vs.20
a. That they abstain (to beware of pollution from the use of meats left from the
heathen sacrifices) from pollutions of idols.
b. That they abstain from fornication.
c. That they abstain from things strangled (pertaining to choked or strangled
Louw-Nida)
d. That they abstain from the blood.
4. Preventing offense of the Jews was the basis of the instructions given by James.
vs.21



II. A COUNCIL OF THE EARLY CHURCH ESTABLISHED THAT THE GENTILES WERE
NEVER DESIGNED TO BE UNDER LAW. Acts 15:22-35
87
A. The apostles and the elders wrote letters to the Gentiles to be taken back into Antioch in
order to settle the matter of whether they had to obey the Mosaic law. vs. 22-23


B. The letter sent by the apostles and elders was meant to put the Gentiles at ease concerning
the issue of the Mosaic law. vs.24
1. The Judiazers had troubled (to cause one inward commotion, take away his
calmness of mind, disturb his equanimity; to disquiet, make restless) them with
words.
2. The Judiazers had subverted (to turn away violently from a right state, to unsettle
) their souls.
3. There were two sources of the troubling and subverting done by the Judiazers.
a. They contended that the Gentiles must be circumcised.
b. They contended that the Gentiles must keep the law.
4. The authority of the apostles and elders is seen in the statement to whom we gave
no such commandment (diaste,llomai to admonish, order, charge Thayer)
Matt. 16:20
a. They chose men who had hazarded (given over, betrayed) their lives
(souls) to travel with Barnabas and Paul vs.25-26
b. They sent Judas and Silas also to tell them the same thing by mouth. vs.27

C. The edict the apostles and elders gave the Gentiles was inspired by the Holy Spirit. vs. 28-
29

D. The group was dismissed and delivered the letter to Antioch. vs.30
1. They assembled the multitude.
2. They gave them the epistle.

E. The Gentiles were glad to receive the letter. vs.31
1. They rejoiced. vs.31a
2. They were encouraged which led to their joy. vs.31a
3. Prophets Judas and Silas exhorted them with many words.
4. Prophets Judas and Silas confirmed (epesthrixan -- to cause someone to become
stronger in the sense of more firm and unchanging in attitude or belief - 'to
strengthen, to make more firmLouwNida) them.

F. Judas and Silas remained in Antioch awhile before they where let go in peace
1. From the brethren
2. To the apostles.

G. Silas remained in Antioch. vs.34 (textual problem, not in best manuscripts)

H. Paul and Barnabas continued in Antioch. vs.35
1. They continued, teaching the word of the Lord.
2. They continued, preaching the word of the Lord.

88



III. PAUL AND BARNABAS SEPARATE OVER THEIR DISAGREEMENT ABOUT JOHN
MARK. Acts 15:36-41
A. Paul asked Barnabas to go again to see the brethren in every city in which they preached
the word of the Lord to see how they do. vs.36
1. The term go again is a form of epistrepheo which is to turn to or toward
something.
2. Paul wanted to go back into every city in which they proclaimed the word
concerning the Lord.

B. Barnabas determined to take John Mark with them. vs.37

C. Paul thought it not good to take him with them. vs.38
1. John Mark departed from them from Pamphylia.
2. John Mark went not with them to the work.

D. A disagreement developed between Barnabas and Paul over the issue.
1. The contention was sharp.
2. They departed one from the other.
3. Barnabas took John Mark and sailed into Cyprus (the first stop on the 1
st
journey).
4. Paul chose Silas.
a. He departed being recommended by the brethren into the
Grace of God.
b. He went through Syria and Cilicia, confirming the churches.




















89



Chapter 16
(A.D.51-54)



I. THE APOSTLE PAUL BEGINS HIS SECOND APOSTOLIC JOURNEY WITH NEW
PARTNERS.
A. In addition to Silas, Paul meets Timothy, a man who becomes one of his trusted co-
workers.vs.1
1. Timothy was raised in Derbe.
2. Timothys mother was a Jewess who believed the gospel. (See also 2 Tim. 1:
3. Timothys father was a Greek (a person who participates in Greek culture and in so
doing would speak the Greek language, but not necessarily a person of Greek
ethnic background Louw-Nida).
4. Timothy was well reported of (he was continually having had a good testimony
or witness) by the brethren at Lystra and Iconium. (this indicates that Timothy had
possibly become a believer during Pauls first apostolic journey --- ill. 1 Tim. 1:2; 2
Tim. 2:2)
5. Paul desired to take Timothy with him on his apostolic journey. vs.3
a. The term would is he desired.
b. Go forth is the term exelqeinto go out.
c. With him is an intimate term used to denote partnership in Scripture. (ill.
Acts 5:17,21; 19:38)
d. He had Timothy circumcised because of the Jews they would encounter.
(A practice of the Jews based upon the covenant of circumcision given to
Abraham in the third Abrahamic Covenant -- Acts 7:8;Gen. 17; 10-14)
i. The Jews existing in that area was acquainted with Timothys father.
ii. The Jews existing in that area knew the facts that his father was living
as a Greek

B. The we term in vs.10 (11,12,13) indicates the first time that Dr. Luke joins Paul and
begins to give a first hand account Pauls episodes.

C. Paul and Silas and the ones with them delivered the decrees (do, gmata -- a formalized rule
(or set of rules) prescribing what people must do - 'law, ordinance, rule.' The difference
between 'a law' and 'a command' is that a law is enforced by sanctions from a society,
while a command carries only the sanctions of the individual who commands. When,
however, the people of Israel accepted the commands of God as the rules which they
would follow and enforce, these became their laws. Louw-Nida) from the council at
Jerusalem to the Gentiles. vs.4

D. Two things result from the decrees handed down by the church in Jerusalem. vs.5
1. The believers were established (stere, ow -- figuratively, of firm beliefs and
90
attitudes be strengthened -- Friegberg) by the faith.
2. The church increased (abounded) in number daily.


II. THE HOLY SPIRIT LED PAUL AND SILAS INTO CERTAIN REGIONS ON THE SECOND
APOSTOLIC JOURNEY AND PREVENTED THEM FROM GOING INTO OTHERS.
A. They passed through Phyrgia and the region of Galatia. vs.6
1. They were gone through (et. ,eat: to complete movement in a particular
direction - 'to move on to, to go on toLouw-Nida ill. Acts 13:14; 14:24)
2. The term region of Galatia appears also in Acts 18:23

B. They were forbidden (to withhold a thing from anyone, i. e. to deny or refuse one a
thing Joseph Thayer -- ill. Mk. 10:14) by the Holy Spirit from preaching the word in Asia.
1. They were forbidden to by the Holy Spirit.
2. They were forbidden to speak the Word in Asia (Ephesus, Philadelphia etc..)

C. They assayed (could be translated, they kept on attempting) to go (proceed for
themselves) into Bithynia.
1. Bithynia is the nearest point to Europe; bounded by Paphlagonia on the E., by the
Euxine on the N., by the Propontis on the W, by Mysia, Phrygia, and Galatia on
the S. Bithynia was originally bequeathed to Rome by Nicomedes III, 74 B.C., the
last of the kings, one of whom invited the Gauls; whence the central province was
called Gallo-Graecia or Galatia. Faussets Bible Dictionary
2. The Holy Spirit suffered them not (.:t. :. -- to allow someone to do
something - 'to allow, to let, to permit Louw-Nida) to go there. ill. Acts 14:16;
1 Co. 10:13

D. They passed by Mysia and entered into Troas. vs.8-10
1. Paul spent a lot of time at Troas throughout his apostolic journeys. Acts 20:6-12
2. Paul saw a vision (the result of an act of gazingthe eyes are open ill. Acts
7:31).
a. He saw a man (a| -- an adult male person of marriageable age - man) of
Macedonia.
b. The man prayed (parakalew to beech; beg) him: come over (pass
through, to come over) into Macedonia, and help us (aor. imper. of
BonQhson to help).
3. After Paul had seen the vision they endeavored (,. .: to try to learn the
location of something, often by movement from place to place in the process of
searching - 'to try to learn where something is, to look for, to try to find) to go (for
the purpose of going) into Macedonia.
a. They were assuredly (to cause to coalesce, to join together, put together)
because of the vision. (ill. Acts 9:22)
b. They concluded that the Lord had called (summoned) them to (for the
purpose of) preaching the gospel unto them. (see 2 Co. 2:12)

E. They loosed from Troas and headed for Macedonia.
91
1. They made a straight course into Samothracia (an island of the Aegean Sea,
about 38 miles distant from the coast of Thrace where the river Hebrus empties
into the sea) and then into Neapolis. vs.11
2. They left Neapolis and entered into Philippi.

F. Philippi was the chief city of the part of Macedonia. vs.12
1. Philippi took its name from Philip I. of Macedon, who built it up from a village.
2. Philippi was a colony (se.|t a -- a city or town with special privileges in that
the inhabitants of such a town were regarded as Roman citizens (such towns were
originally colonized by citizens of Rome).
2. They abode (remained) there certain days.


III. PAUL AND SILAS ENCOUNTERED PROBLEMS AMONG THE GENTILES OF PHILIPPI.
A. Paul and Silas dont seek out a synagogue in Philippi but go down to the riverside. vs.13
1. They went outside the city.
2. They went alongside a river.
3. It was on the Sabbath.
4. It was the wont(They weresupposing it to be a place) for prayer to be made
there.
5. Paul and Silas sat down and began speaking unto the women, which resorted
(come together, gather, assemble) there.

B. A certain woman stood out to Paul and Silas. vs.14-15
1. Her name was Lydia.
2. She was a seller of purple (Thyatira was famous for its dyeing. There was a great
demand for this fabric as it was used for the official toga at Rome and in the
Roman colonies Reinecker/Rogers) from the city of Thyatira.
3. She worshipped (to express in attitude and ritual of one's allegiance to and
regard for deity - 'to worship, to venerate) God.
4. The Lord opened her heart that she should attend to the things, which were
spoken of Paul.
a. The term for opened is to open the mind of one, i. e. cause him to
understand a thing, to open one's soul, i. e. to rouse in one the faculty of
understanding or the desire of learning, (ill. Lk. 24; 32,45)
b. The term for attend is to be in a continuous state of readiness to learn of any
future danger, need, or error, and to respond appropriately - 'to pay
attention to, to keep on the lookout for, to be alert for, to be on one's guard
against the things spoken by Paul. (ill. Heb. 2:1)
5. She and her household (relatives, servants etc) were baptized.
6. She besought Paul and his entourage to abide at her house.
a. She besought them since they judged (kekrinw -- to come to a conclusion
in the process of thinking and thus to be in a position to make a decision
to come to a conclusion, to decide, to make up one's mind perf. Act.) her
faithful in the Lord (rather to the Lord)
b. She constrained (compel by employing force (Polybius 26, 1, 3): t|a, to
92
constrain one by entreaties. -- Luke 24:29) them to stay there.



C. Paul cast a demon out of a slave girl in Philippi. vs.16-18
1. The damsel was possessed with a spirit of divination. vs.16a
a. A damsel is a young female slave girl. (ill. Acts 12:7)
b. A spirit of divination is the Greek word puqwn phthon, prophecy. The word
was used for the serpent that guarded the Delphic oracle and later was
slain by Apollo. The word came to designate spirit of divination, then also a
ventriloquist, who was believed to have such a spirit dwelling in his belly.
2. The damsel brought her masters much gain by means of her soothsaying (to
function as a more or less professional predicter of future events for the sake of a
fee - 'to tell fortunes). vs.16b
3. The damsel followed (saaseeu. .-- to come/go behind or after, with the
possible implication of continual and determined action - 'to follow along behind,
to keep on followingLouw-Nida) Paul and his entourage. vs.17
a. She cried, these men are the men of the most high God.
b. She cried that they show unto us the way of salvation.
4. The damsel followed them for many days. vs.18
a. She kept on doing the same thing over the course of many days.
b. She grieved (eta:e|. eat -- to be strongly irked or provoked at
something or someone - 'to be irked, to be provoked, to become angry
Louw-Nida ill. Acts 4:2) Paul with her persistent crying.
c. Paul turned and spoke to the spirit.
i. He commanded the spirit to come out of her in the name of Jesus
Christ. (ill. Acts 3:6;4:10)
ii. The spirit came out in the same hour.

D. The masters of the damsel reacted to her loss of ability due to the casting out of the spirit.
vs.19-24
1. They caught (.:taa |eat --to take hold of or grasp, with focus upon the goal
of the motion - 'to take hold of, to grasp Louw-Nida) Paul and Silas. vs.19a
2. They drew (dragged) them into the market place (court house) unto the rulers.
vs.19b
3. They brought them to the magistrates (governmental officials). vs. 20a
4. They gave these charges against them. vs.20b-21
a. They pointed out that the men being () Jews.
b. They pointed out that they exceedingly trouble (.saacc. -- to cause
people to riot against - 'to stir up against, to start a riot, to cause an uproar
-- Ac 17.5. Lk 23.5. Acts 21.30) the city.
c. They teach(proclaim) customs (religious practices), which are not lawful
(permissible)
i. For us to receive (welcome).
ii. For us to observe (practice), being Romans
5. The multitude rose up together (cu|.|t ct-- rise up together, against one)
93
against them. vs.22a
6. The magistrates: vs.22b
i. Rent off their clothes
ii. Commanded they beat (rabidzein to beat with rods. The beating
with rods was done by the lectors as a means of police coercion
Reinecker/Rogers) them.
7. They cast them into prison. vs.23
a. Having laid many stripes (wounds) upon them.
b. Charging the jailer to keep them safely (under close guard) .


IV. THE BEST PREVENTATIVE METHODS OF THE JAILERS DID NOT PREVENT THE
RELEASE OF PAUL AND SILAS.
A. The jailers tied their best to secure their prisoners. vs.24
1. They thrust them into the inner prison.
2. They made their feet fast in the stocks (u e| wood, stock. A Roman
instrument of torture with more than two holes for the legs so that they could be
forced widely apart unto a position, which soon became intolerably painful).

B. The response of Paul and Silas to their circumstance was consistent with their trust in God.
vs.25
1. They prayed (were worshipping ill. Eph. 6:18at midnight.
2. They sang praises (hymn zing a sign of being spiritual Eph. 5:19; Col. 3:16)
unto God at midnight.
3. The prisoners heard them.

C. God provided for the release of Paul and Silas from prison through a great earthquake. vs.26
1. The foundations of the prison were shaken (ca.u .-- to cause something to move
back and forth rapidly, often violently - 'to shake).
2. All the doors were opened immediately.
3. The bands of all were loosed.

D. The keeper of the prison resigned himself to the doom he would face for escaped prisoners.
vs. 27-28
1. Seeing the prison doors opened after awakening out of his sleep, he: vs.27
a. Drew out his sword to kill himself
b. He was supposing the prisoners had fled.
2. Paul and Barnabas stayed put after the earthquake and urged the keeper not to do
harm to himself. vs.28

E. The decision of Paul and Barnabas not to escape left an impression upon the keeper of the
prison. vs.29-30
1. He called for a light.
2. He sprang (rushed quickly) in.
3. He came trembling and fell down before Paul and Silas.
4. He brought them out (of the prison).
94
5. He inquired as to what (e.t -- to be that which must necessarily take place, often
with the implication of inevitability - 'to be necessary, must) he could do to be
saved.



F. Paul and Silas led the Philippian jailer to the Lord. vs.31-32
1. They told him to believe upon the Lord Jesus Christ.
a. This belief would result in him being saved.
b. This belief would result in his household being saved.
2. They spake unto him the word of the Lord.
3. They spake unto all that were in his house.


G. The jailer tried to make amends for his part in Paul and Silas problems. vs.33-34
1. He washed their stripes.
2. He was baptized.
3. All his household were baptized.
4. He took Paul and Silas into his house.
a. He fed them.
b. He rejoiced.
c. He continued believing in God with his entire house.


H. The magistrates had a change of heart by morning. vs.35-37
1. They order them to be let go. vs.35-36
2. Paul refused to leave due to the unjust treatment they received. vs.37
a. He asserted that they had beat them openly
b. He asserted that they had beaten them uncondemned, even though they
were Romans. (It was unlawful to beat an uncondemned Roman citizen --
Acts 23:25-29)
c. Paul asserted that they cast us into prison.
d. Paul asserted that they were now trying to thrust them out privily.
e. Paul asserted that the magistrates should come to them to let them out.

J. Pauls comments brought fear to the magistrates. vs.38-39
1. They feared because they were Romans.
a. This was a fact that the rebel rousers neglected to point out when they
brought Paul and Silas before the magistrates. (vs.20)
2. They besought them.
3. They brought them out.
4. They desired them to depart out of the city.

K. Paul and Silas left the prison after the magistrates personal appearance.
1. They went out of the prison.
2. They entered into the house of Lydia.
95
3. They comforted the brethren and departed.


Chapter 17
(A.D. 51-54 )



I. TROUBLE FOR PAUL AND SILAS CONTINUE IN MACEDONIA BEGINNING IN THE
CITY OF THESSALONICA.
A. Paul renews his custom in Thessonalica of taking the message of the gospel into the Jewish
synagogue. vs.1-2
1. Thessonalica was a large and populous city on the Thermaic bay. It was the capital
of one of the four Roman districts of Macedonia, and was ruled by a praetor. It
was named after Thessalonica, the wife of Cassander, who built the city. She was
so called by her father, Philip, because he first heard of her birth on the day of his
gaining a victory over the Thessalians.
2. Paul demonstrated two customs when he entered a city with a Jewish synagogue:
a. He entered the synagogue on the Sabbath.
b. He lectured to the adherents from the Scriptures (Old Testament
Scriptures). Rom. 15:4; Acts 18:28
3. Paul had two directives in mind when he lectured the Jews:
a. He opening -- to open the mind of one, i. e. cause him to
understand a thing. Luke 24:45
b. He alleging setting something before someone with the
expectation of a response. Context. ill.1Co. 10:27
4. The object of Pauls opening of Scripture and alleging was the fact
that Jesus, the one whom the Jews killed was the Messiah they had expected and that
the Old Testament proved that two things were necessary for the Messiah to
experience: vs.3
a. Paul asserted that the Old Testament Scriptures prove that it was
necessary for Messiah to suffer. Ps. 22:1-19; Is. 53
b. Paul asserted that Old Testament Scriptures prove that it was
necessary for Messiah to be raised from the dead. Lk. 9:22; 18:32-33
c. Paul asserted that Jesus was the Messiah that the Jews had anticipated.

B. Pauls persuaded a few of those meeting in the Synagogue. vs.4
1. Those out from among the Jews that believed consorted -- to begin an association
with someone, whether temporary or permanent - 'to join, to join oneself to, to
become a part of. -- Louw-Nida (ill. Acts 5:36)
2. There were two groups of people who joined them:
a. Some of those who were devout Greeks.
b. Some of the Jewish women.

C. The Jews who were not persuaded, took action against Paul and Silas. vs.5
1. They gathered for themselves lewd fellows of the baser sort (porneros ill. Lk.
96
6:45) men.
2. They formed a mob with the evil men.
3. They set the city in an uproar -- to stir up against, to start a riot, to cause an
uproar. Lowa-Nida (ill. Mt 26.5)
4. They confronted Jason, Paul and Silas host desiring to lead him into the crowd.

D. The Jews made false accusations against Jason and other brethren. vs.6a
1. When they couldnt find Paul and Silas, they drug Jason and other brethren to the
administration of civil affairs (Louw-Nida).
2. They accused Jason and the believers of turning the world upside down. vs.6b-7
a. The word for world in this passage is oikomena which is used of the
inhabited world everywhere people dwell as opposed to areas that are
unoccupied.
b. They accused them of turning the world upside down is the Greek word
anastatountes which means to cause people to rebel against or to reject
authority - 'to incite to revolt, to cause to rebel. Louw-Nida (ill. Gal. 5:12)
c. They accused Jason of welcoming them for his own benefit. vs.7a
d. They accused them of practicing decrees contrary to Cesar by saying there
was another (of a different kind of king) Jesus. vs.7b

E. The people and the rulers of the city were troubled (to render anxious or distressed, to
perplex the mind of one by suggesting scruples or doubts -- Joseph Thayer) over the
accusations. vs.8 (ill. Acts 15:24)

F. The authorities took security (either by accepting sponsors, or by a deposit of money
until the case had been decided Joseph Thayer) from Jason and the other believers they
released them. vs.9

G. The brethren set Paul out of Thessonalica due to the danger. vs.10
1. They immediately sent him through the night (under the cloak of darkness
ill.Acts 23:31) Paul and Silas out of Thessonalica.
2. They sent them to Berea (A town of southwestern Macedonia, in the district of
Emathia. It lay at the foot of Mt. Bermius, on a tributary of the Haliacmon, and
seems to have been an ancient town, though the date of its foundation is uncertain.
A passage in Thucydides (i.61) relating to the year 432 BC probably refers to
another place of the same name, but an inscription (Inscr Graec, II, 5, 296i)
proves its existence at the end of the 4th century BC, and it is twice mentioned by
Polybius (xxvii.8; xxviii.8). After the battle of Pydba in 168 BC Berea was the first
city to surrender to Rome and fell in the third of the four regions into which
Macedonia was divided -- I.S.B.E.
3. Upon their arrival they entered into the synagogue of the Jews.


II. TROUBLE CONTINUES FOR PAUL AND SILAS IN BEREA.
A. The Bereans accepted the word of God spoken to them by Paul and Silas. vs.11
1. They were more noble (.u,.|. steroi --pertaining to having high status, with the
97
possible implication of special family relations contributing to such status - 'high
status, important. Lowa- Nida) ill. Lk. 19:12; 1 Co. 1:26
a. The term eugenesteroi is used in the comparative degree to denote the
superiority of their status.
b. The Bereans received (to receive favorably, give ear to, embrace,
make one's own, approve, not to reject Joseph Thayer) the word of
God.
c. The Bereans received the Word of God with all readiness of mind
(eagerness to engage in some activity or event - 'eagerness, desire
Louw-Nida).
2. Because the Bereans were more noble they searched the Scriptures daily. vs.11
a. The word searched is a|ast |. which means to try to learn the nature or
truth of something by the process of careful study, evaluation and judgment
- 'to examine carefully, to investigate, to study thoroughly Louw Nida (ill.
1 Co. 9:3)
b. The Scriptures they searched were the Old Testament Scriptures that were
available, but expensive.
c. The purpose of their search was to see if the things in the Scriptures were as
Paul and Silas said they were. (ill. vs.3)

3. Many out from among the Bereans believed. vs12
a. The term honorable women were those women who were of good standing,
honorable, influential, wealthy, respectable Joseph Thayer
b. The term not a few means there were many who believed among the Jewish
men.

B. The Jews from Thessonalica gained knowledge that the Word of God was preached in Berea
by Paul and travel there to undermine him. vs.13
1. The Jews got experiential knowledge of the fact that Paul was proclaiming the Word
of God in Berea.
2. The Jews stirred up (is made up of two different Greek words) the crowd in Berea.
a. Saleuo (ca.u .-- to cause something to move back and forth rapidly,
often violently - 'to shake Louw-Nida ill. 2 Thess. 2:2)
b. Kakei is the word for to do that which is lacking in character in this case,
they cause the minds of the crowd to be shaken towards consideration of that
which is evil.

C. Paul was sent away by the brethren from Berea, while Silas and Timothy remained there.
vs.14
1. The word remained (to endure, bear bravely and calmly: absolutely, ill-treatment
Joseph Thayer) ill. Heb. 12:2; 1 Pet. 2:20 emphasize the fact that Silas and
Timothy were not having a good time while they stayed in Bereaa.
2. Paul was sent as far as the sea (the Aegaean Sea where he sailed into Athens).
a. The ones that conducted (assign to someone a position of authority over
others - 'to put in charge of, to appoint, to designate Louw-Nida) ill. Acts
13:5 vs.15a
98
b. Paul summoned Silas and Timothy to join him in Athens. vs.15b



III. PAUL TURNS TO DEBATE AS A MEANS OF SPREADING THE WORD OF GOD.
A. The pagan conditions in Athens stirred (aeuce , -- to irritate, provoke, rouse to anger
ill. 13:50; Heb. 10:24) to debate the validity of the heathen practices with those on Mars
hill. vs.16

B. Several words are commonly used of Pauls spreading the Word of God up this point in the
book of Acts.
1. Proclaim (saa,,. . -- to announce, with focus upon the extent to which the
announcement or proclamation extends - 'to proclaim throughout, to announce, to
speak out about). (Acts 13:5; 15:36)
2. Preached (a. .: to speak or talk, with the possible implication of more informal
usage (though this cannot be clearly and consistently shown from NT contexts)
'to speak, to say, to talk, to tell) (Acts 13:42, 43; 14:1; 16:6)
3. Speaking boldly (pacta ,ea -- to speak openly about something and with
complete confidence - 'to speak boldly, to speak openly). Acts 14:3
4. To speak Good News (.ua,,.t cacat -- in the N. T. used especially of the glad
tidings of the coming kingdom of God, and of the salvation to be obtained in it
through Christ, and of what relates to this salvation Joseph Thayer) Acts
14:21; 15:7; 16:10
C. Provoked by the idolatry in Athens, Paul turns to debate as a means of winning those in
Athens. vs.17
1. The word for debate is Dialegeto (diele, geto to argue about differences of
opinion - 'to argue, to dispute --Acts 18:4; 20:7) which is only used in this form two
other times in the book of Acts.ill. Lk. 9:46
2. Paul disputed in the synagogue with the Jews and those who were devout.
3. Paul disputed in the market (a commercial center with a number of places for
doing business - 'market, marketplace, business center -- Louw-Nida) with those
that (happen to be present, to meet by chance) met him there.
D. Certain philosophers were eager to debate with Paul.
1. The Epicureans --pertaining to the philosophical system of the Greek philosopher
Epicurus, who taught that the world is a series of fortuitous combinations of atoms
and that the highest good is pleasure.
2. The Stoics -- - pertaining to the philosophical system of the Greek philosopher
Zeno, who taught that people should be free from excessive joy or grief and submit
without complaint to necessity.
3. These two encountered (to give careful consideration to various implications of
an issue - 'to reflect on, to think about seriously, to think deeply about
LouwNida) Paul.
99
E. The Greek philosophers were condescending towards Pauls message.
1. Some called him a babbler (c:.ee,e, -- a figurative extension of meaning of a
term based on the practice of birds in picking up seeds, one who acquires bits and
pieces of relatively extraneous information and proceeds to pass them on with
pretense and show - 'ignorant show-off, charlatan).
2. Some thought he advocated strange (demons) because he preached the resurrection
of Jesus Christ from the dead.
F. Paul was taken by the philosophers up to the Areopagus (a rocky height in the city of
Athens not far from the Acropolis toward the west; :a ,e, a hill,: A.te, belonging to
(Ares) Mars, Mars' Hill; so called, because, as the story went, Mars, having slain
Halirrhothius, son of Neptune, for the attempted violation of his daughter Alcippe, was
tried for the murder here before the twelve gods as judges) for further examination of his
teaching. vs.19-20
1. The philosophers wanted to know the details of Pauls new (kind) doctrine. vs.19
2. The new kind of doctrine raised the curiosity of the philosophers.vs.20
3. The Athenians and visitors to the Areopagus spent much of their time doing two
things:
a. To speak some new thing.
b. To hear some new thing.

IV. THE APOSTLE PAUL DELIVERS A MESSAGE DESIGNED TO TURN THE CROWD
FROM SERVING IDOL GODS TO THE TRUE AND LIVING GOD. vs.22-23
A. Paul begins the message focused upon the Athenians faith in a higher being.
1. The word superstitious (e.tcteat.|) may occur in either a good or a bad
sense; that is to say, it may mean either 'very religious' or 'superstitious,'
although the meaning of 'superstitious' is primarily a later development in
the meaning of this word. In Ac 17.22 there seems every reason to believe
that Paul was using the term in a positive sense. Louw-Nida (ill. Acts
25:19) vs.22
2. Paul came that conclusion based as he perceived (to view attentively, take a
view of, survey; to view mentally, consider Joseph Thayer --John 4:19
3. Paul observed their devotions (objects of worship). vs.23a
4. Paul noticed among their devotions an altar (an elevated place; very frequent in
Greek writings from Homer down, a raised place on which to offer sacrifice) to an
unknown God. vs.23b
5. The Athenians were ignorant (ill. Rom. 10:3) of the true God. vs.23c
B. Paul gives the Athenians a discourse on the true God. vs. 24
1. He made the world (Kosmos technical usage for all of creation). vs.24a
2. He made all the things in it. vs.24b
3. He is Lord (Master) of Heaven and Earth. vs.24c
4. He does not dwell in temples made with hands. (ill. Acts 7:47-50)
5. He is not worshipped (served for the need of survival) by the hands of men. vs.25a
6. He is the one that gives life (the state of one who is possessed of vitality or is
100
animate) and breath (:|.. -- air in relatively rapid movement, but without
specification as to the force of the movement - 'wind, blowing, to blow) and all
things. (out of His goodness) vs.25c
7. He made out of one blood (man) all nations of men (Gen. 10:5) to dwell (settle
down and feel at ease) upon all the face of the earth. vs.26a
8. He determined (orisasmarked off) the times (kairous seasonsproper
time for something to occur 1 Co. 4; 5; Acts 1:7 ;) before appointed (to give
detailed instructions as to what must be done - 'to order, to instruct, to tell, to
command). vs. 26b
9. He determined the bounds of their habitation (orothesias --a setting of
boundaries, laying down limits).
C. Paul explains to the Athenians why God made determinations for the times and habitation of
men. vs.27
1. So that men could seek God. vs.27a
2. The term if haply (.t a ac) means that a possibility exist that something
could happen as a result of Gods action. (ill. Mk. 11:13) vs.27b
a. Gods determinations make it possible that men might feel after (to
touch by feeling and handling, implying movement over a surface -
'to touch, to feel, to handle, to feel around for) Him.
b. Gods determinations make it possible that men might find Him. 3.
3. God is not existing away from men. vs.27b-28
a. Men live in (the essence) Him.
b. Men move in (the essence) Him.
c. Men exist in (the essence) Him.
4. An Athenian poet Aratus advanced the idea that men originated from God.

D. Paul tried to steer the Athenians away from paganistic concepts of the true God. vs.29
1. Paul warned that the members of the Godhead should not be liken to corruptible
things which is mans habit to do. vs.29a (ill. Rom. 1:23)
2. God winked (to overlook, to purposely pay no attention to, disregard) at this
view of him in the times of ignorance. vs.30a
3. God now commands all men everywhere to repent (have a change of mind about
the true God --- Acts 26:20; 1 Thess. 1:9) vs. 30b
4. They should repent because He has appointed a day of judgment for the
world. vs.31 (ill. 2 Tim. 4:1)

C. The Athenians were cool to Pauls assertion of Christs resurrection from the dead.
vs.32
E. Paul departed out of their midst. vs. 33

F. Certain ones out from the Athenians believed and joined themselves to Paul. vs. 34


101


Chapter 18
(A.D. 51-54 )


I. PAUL JOURNEYED FROM MARS HILL AND ENTERED INTO CORINTH.
A. Paul entered into Corinth upon his departure from Athens. vs.1
1. The term departure is in the passive voice denoting someone caused Paul to
leave Athens and go into Corinth (possibly the Holy Spirit)
2. Corinth -- the Phoenicians, who settled in Corinth, left many traces of
their civilization in the industrial arts, such as dyeing and weaving, as well
as in their religion and mythology. The Corinthian cult of Aphrodite, of
Melikertes (Melkart) and of Athene Phoenike are of Phoenician origin.
Poseidon, too, and other sea deities were held in high esteem in the
commercial city. Various arts were cultivated and the Corinthians, even in
the earliest times, were famous for their cleverness, inventiveness and
artistic sense, and they prided themselves on surpassing the other Greeks in
the embellishment of their city and in the adornment of their temples. There
were many celebrated painters in Corinth, and the city became famous for
the Corinthian order of architecture: an order, which, by the way, though
held in high esteem by the Romans, was very little used by the Greeks
themselves. It was here, too, that (hymn to Dionysus) was first arranged
artistically to be sung by a chorus; and the Isthmian games, held every two
years, were celebrated just outside the city on the isthmus near the Saronic
Gulf. But the commercial and materialistic spirit prevailed later. Not a
single Corinthian distinguished himself in literature. Statesmen, however,
there were in abundance: Periander, Phidon, Timoleon. I.S.B.E.


B. Paul met two trusted companions Aquila and his wife Priscilla at Corinth. vs.2
1. The couple along with other Jews were dismissed from Rome around a.d. 52
because of a reported uprising among the Jews.
2. Aquila and Paul were both tent makers.
3. The couple were an encouragement to Paul and to others during the course of
his ministry.
a. Paul considered them his co-workers in the Lord. Rom. 16:3
b. The couple hosted a church in their home. 1 Co. 16:19
c. The couple helped guided Apollos to the correct doctrine for the
Dispensation of grace. Acts 18:26


II. PAUL LIMITED HIS MESSAGE TO THE CORINTHIANS UNTIL THE ARRIVAL OF
SILAS AND TIMOTHY.
102
A. Before Silas and Timothys arrival, Paul reasoned in the synagogue every Sabbath.
vs.4
1. He reasoned (lectured, debated) in the Synagogue on the sabbath.
2. He persuaded (to persuade, i. e. to induce one by words to believe --
Joseph Thayer) Jews and the Greeks.

B. Paul got back to the message when Silas and Timothy came from Macedonia. vs.5
1. Their arrival caused Paul to be pressed in the spirit
a. Joseph Thayer -- to hold completely, i. e. a. to hold fast; properly,
a prisoner; metaphorically, in the passive, to be held by, closely
occupied with. Acts 18:5
b. Liddell & Scott -- to constrain or force one to a thing,
c. Friberg Lexicon -- being totally claimed by a task devote oneself
completely to, be occupied with; he was wholly absorbed in
preaching.
2. Their arrival caused Paul to witness to the Jews that Jesus was the Christ (the
Messiah in whom they had awaited)

C. The Jews in Corinth rejected Pauls message that Jesus was the Messiah. vs.6
1. They opposed themselves (a|tacc. only middle in the NT; strictly set in
array against; as setting oneself against oppose, resist, be hostile toward
Friberg Lexicon)
2. They blasphemed (specifically, of those who by contemptuous speech
intentionally come short of the reverence due to God or to sacred things --
Joseph Thayer)
3. Paul shook his raiment (by this symbolic act a person expresses extreme
contempt for another and refuses to have any further contact with him
Joseph Thayer ill. Matt. 10:14)
4. Paul turned (to pursue the journey on which one has entered, continue
one's journey) to the Gentiles.

D. Paul departed the synagogue and entered the house of Justus whose house joined
hard (cu|eee,-- having joint boundaries, bordering on) to the synagogue. vs.7

E. Pauls ministry bore fruit in Corinth. vs.8
1. Crispus, the chief ruler of the synagogue believed.
2. Many of the Corinthians believed and were baptized.

F. Pauls time in Macedonia took a toll on him to the point he had to be reassured by a
personal appearance from the Lord. vs.9
1. The Lord appeared to Paul in a vision (one of many times He had promised to
appear to Paul Acts 26:16; 2 Tim. 4:16-17)
2. The Lord encouraged Paul to be not afraid (The negative in the imperative
tense should read: stop being afraid for Paul was afraid as he wrote to the
Corinthians of his state of mind when he came to them. 1 Co. 2:3)
3. On the contrary, the Lord told Paul to speak. (He had been afraid to do so
103
until Silas and Timothy arrived from Thessonalica vs.5)
4. The term hold not thy peace (dont think about being silent).

G. The Lord gave Paul three reasons as to why he should stop being afraid. vs.10
1. The Lord was with (meta ) you.
2. No man shall set on thee (to attack or make an assault upon Joseph
Thayer) you.
3. The Lord had much people (many people that belonged to Him) in Corinth.

H. Paul continued there a year and six months teaching them the Word from God. vs.11


III. THE JEWS AT CORINTH CONSIPRED AGAINST PAUL AND RAISED AN
INSURRECTION AND BROUGHT HIM BEFORE THE JUDGEMENT SEAT. 12-17
A. Gallio was (according to extra-canonical references) was born at Cordova, but
came to Rome in the reign of Tiberius. He was the brother of the philosopher
Seneca, by whom, as also by Statius, reference is made to the affable nature of his
character. As Achaia was reconstituted a proconsular province by Claudius in 44
AD, the accession of Gallio to office must have been subsequent to that date, and
has been variously placed at 51-53 AD The trial was not of long duration. Although
Gallio extended his protection to the Jewish religion as one of the religions
recognized by the state, he contemptuously rejected the claim of the J ews that their
law was binding upon all. In the eyes of the proconsul, the only law universally
applicable was that of the Roman code and social morality: under neither was the
prisoner chargeable; therefore, without even waiting to hear Paul's speech in his
own defense, he summarily ordered his lictors to clear the court. I.S.B.E.

B. The Roman policy was not to get involve in the laws of Israel that didnt conflict
with Roman law.
1. This is illustrated in the Jews bringing of Jesus before Pilate. John 18:31
2. This is illustrated in the Jews bringing of Paul before Festus. Acts 25:17-19

C. The Jews made insurrection (to use sudden physical force against someone as
the outgrowth of a hostile attitude - 'to attack, to assault. Louw-Nida) with one
accord against Paul and brought him to the judgment (bema) seat. vs.12

D. Their one accusation against Paul is that he persuadeth men to worship God
contrary to the law. vs.13
1. The word persuadeth means to solicit, incite (Thayer).
2. Worship is the word sebesqai (to be devoted or dedicated to) God.

E. Gallio would not bear with the Jews attempts to prosecute Paul upon the basis of
Roman law giving two standards for Roman intervention. vs.14
1. A wrong (aetsa -- a completed act of deliberate wrongdoing wrong,
crimeFreiberg Lexiconill. Acts 24:20)
2. Wicked lewdness is thoughtless, reckless action, prank, regarded as a
104
serious offense against law that is lacking and character and influences
others into that same type of behavior (i.e. one who spurs an insurrection).

F. Gallio argued that matters concerning the Jews religion should be judged under
Israels law. vs.15
1. The idea of questions (to express forceful differences of opinion without
necessarily having a presumed goal of seeking a solution - 'to dispute,
dispute Louw-Nida Acts 23:29; 25:19; 26:3)
a. Some disputes were concerned words concerning the law.
b. Some disputes concerned names (the proper name of a person or
object Louw-Nida) concerning the law.
2. Gallio determined not to be a judge over matters of Jewish law.
3. Gallio dismissed them from the judgment seat. vs.16

G. In lieu of Gallios response, some of the people took matters into their own hands.
vs. 17
1. The Greeks in the crowd seized Sosthenes, the synagogue ruler (It was
the ruler's business to control the synagogue services, as for instance to
decide who was to be called upon to read from the Law and the Prophets
and to preach (Acts 13:15; compare Lk 13:14); he had to look after the
discussions, and generally to keep order. I.S.B.E.) and beat him before the
judgment seat.
2. Gallio (because it was concerning Jewish law) cared for none of these
things (to think about something in such a way as to make an appropriate
response - 'to think about, to be concerned about Louw -- Nida).


IV. PAUL CONTINUES TO OBSERVE ELEMENTS OF THE LAW ALONG HIS SECOND
APOSTOLIC JOURNEY. 18-23
A. Paul remained in Corinth a sufficient amount of days. vs.18a

B. Took his leave means (to separate oneself, withdraw oneself from anyone, i. e. to
take leave of, bid farewell toJoseph Thayer) ill. Mark 6:46; Luke 9:61; Acts
18:21 of the brethren. vs. 18b

C. Paul sailed into Syria with Priscilla and Aquila. vs. 18 c

D. A shaven head followed the completion of a Nazirite vow which was conducted
under law. vs.18d
1. There were three kinds of vows in the Old Testament.
a. A vow of devotion.
b. A vow of abstinence.
c. A vow of destruction.
2. The Nazirite vow was made by a layperson of either sex who was bound by a
vow of consecration to Gods service for a specific period of time or in some
cases for life (Lev. 27:2). He could drink no fruit of the vine; coul not cut
105
his hair and could not defile himself by going near a dead person. These
outward signs served as a public testimony of his dedication to God. (ill.
SamsonJ udges 13; Samuel1 Sam. 1:9-11) Ryrie Study Bible note
3. Paul could shave his head because he had completed his vow.

C. Paul traveled from Syria into Ephesus with Priscilla and Aquilla. vs.19
1. He left the couple in Ephesus.
2. He lectured in the Jewish synagogue while in Ephesus.

D. The Jews asked Paul to remain awhile with them and he consented not do stay but
promised to return if it were Gods will. vs.20-21

E. Paul went from Ephesus to Caesarea, greeting the church there and then heading
down into Antioch. vs. 22

F. Paul passed through all the country of Galatia and Phrygia. vs.23
1. Paul passed through them in order (sa.,-- a sequence of one after
another in time, space, or logic - 'in order, in sequence, one after another
Louw-Nida)
2. Paul spent time strengthening (to cause someone to become stronger in
the sense of more firm and unchanging in attitude or belief - 'to strengthen,
to make more firm Louw--Nida) all the disciples. ill. Acts 14:22; 15:41


V. A YOUNG PREACHER NAMED APOLLOS LEARNS THE CORRECT DOCTRINE
FOR THE DISPENSATION OF GRACE. 24-28
A. Apollos was a citizen of Alexandria, Egypt an ancient metropolis of Lower Egypt,
so called from its founder, Alexander the Great (about B.C. 333). It was for a long
period the greatest of existing cities, for both Nineveh and Babylon had been
destroyed, and Rome had not yet risen to greatness. It was the residence of the kings
of Egypt for 200 years. It is not mentioned in the Old Testament, and only
incidentally in the New. Many Jews from Alexandria were in Jerusalem, where they
had a synagogue Ac 6:9 at the time of Stephen's martyrdom. At one time it is said
that as many as 10,000 Jews resided in this city. It possessed a famous library of
700,000 volumes, which was burned by the Saracens (A.D. 642). It was here that the
Hebrew BibleEastons Bible Dictionary

B. Apollos upbringing in Alexandria made him an impressive speaker. vs.24a
1. He was an eloquent (skilled in speech learned, educated, skilled
in knowledge Friberg Lexicon) man.
2. His eloquence was the source of problems at Corinth. 1 Co.1:12;3:3-6, 22;
4:6

C. Apollos was mighty in the Scriptures. vs.24b
1. The term mighty means strong; powerful; able, capable of; influential,
leading; person of strong faith or conscience; well versed. UBS Lexicon.
106
2. The Scriptures is a term used pertaining to the Old Testament Scriptures.
(ill. Matt. 21:42; Lk. 24:47)

D. Apollos was proficient in Gods program up to the Day of Pentecost. vs.25
1. He was taught well in the way of the Lord. vs.25a
a. The term was instructed (to inform by word of mouth; passive to
be orally informed Joseph Thayer ill. Lk. 1:4; Acts 21:21)
b. The way of the Lord pertains to the expectation of the coming
Messiah (ill. Matt. 3:3; Mk. 1:2-3; Lk. 3:4;7:27; John 1:23
2. He was fervent (to show great eagerness toward something - 'to show
enthusiasm, to commit oneself completely to -- Louw Nida) in spirit (mind).
vs. 25b
3. He spoke and taught accurately (pertaining to strict conformity to a norm
or standard, involving both detail and completeness - strict, strictly -- Louw
Nida) the things of the Lord. vs. 25c
a. The things can be better translated the particulars concerning.
b. The Lord can be better translated Jesus.

E. Apollos was limited in his knowledge in that he was knowing (.:tcaa -- to
possess information about, with the implication of an understanding of the
significance of such information) only the purpose of Johns baptism concerning
Jesus. (Acts 13:24-25).

F. Apollos began to speak bodly in the synagogue at Ephesus. vs.26
1. Priscilla and Aquila heard (continually listening) to him.
2. Took him unto them denotes that they received him warmly (ill. Acts 27:36;
28:2)
3. Expounded means that they (to place or set out, expose-- Joseph Thayer --
ill. Lk. 24:27; Acts 11:4).
4. The way (the things concerning the Kingdom of God ill. Acts 10:34-43;
Lk. 1:2-3,14-15) more accurately (precisely -- Acts 23:15,20; 24:22).

G. Apollos determined to go into Achaia. vs.27-28
1. He was disposed (Boulomenou determining for himself).
2. The brethren in Ephesus wrote to those in Achaia exhorting (:e.,. --
to run ahead of someone else, with the implication of arriving at a
destination sooner - 'to run in front of, to run ahead of Louw-Nida) the
disciples to welcome him.
3. Apollos helped (give assistance to, contribute toFriberg Lexicon) those
who had believed through Grace).
a. He convinced (as maintaining a discussion strenuously and
thoroughly vigorously or powerfully refute, confound completely ill.
1 Co. 14:24; Ja. 2:9) the Jews.
b. He convinced by publicly shewing (set forth to be known and
acknowledged as causing to be seen show, exhibit, demonstrate;
figuratively, as proving to be true show beyond doubt, prove,
107
demonstrate convincinglyFriberg Lexicon) from the Scriptures
(Old Testament).
c. He public shewed that Jesus was Christ (,tce| (,t.), the
Septuagint for, anointed; king of Israel (see ,tca), as 1
Sam. 2:10,35; (1 Sam. 24:11; 26:9,11,23); 2 Sam. 1:14; Ps. 2:2; Ps.
17 (Ps. 18:51); Hab. 3:13; (2 Chr. 22:7. --- Joseph Thayer).








































108




Chapter 19
(A.D. 54-58)

I. THE TRANSITION FROM LAW TO GRACE CONTINUES WITH THE TRANSITION
OF JOHNS DISCIPLES INTO THE DISPENSATION OF GRACE. vs. 1-10
A. Ephesus was the next major stop for Paul as he continued his second apostolic
journey. vs.1
1. He traveled to Ephesus while Apollos was in Corinth.
2. He made his way to Ephesus by passing through (denotes to advance on the
journey without stopping ill. Acts 13:6; 14:24) the upper coasts (i. e. the
part of Asia Minor more remote from the Mediterranean, farther east
Thayer).
3. Paul had promised the Ephesians that he would return to them if God willed
(Acts 18:21).

B. Paul found certain disciples of John the Baptist residing in Ephesus. vs.1b-2
1. Paul quizzed the disciples as to whether they received the Holy Spirit when
believing. Several points need to be made about these disciples:
a. They were disciples of John the Baptist who had disciples as Jesus
had disciples (ill. Matt. 11:2; Lk. 11:1)
b. They were already believers.
2. The disciples responded that they had not only had they not received Him,
they hadnt heard (of being informed about something; learn or hear (of))
that there be any Holy Spirit
a. They Holy Spirit hadnt been given during the time Johns or Jesus
ministry. (John 7:37-39)
b. The Holy Spirit did not play a role in salvation until the Dispensation
of Grace. (Acts 10:44-47)
c. These disciples probably had not been in or around Jerusalem for
them not to have heard of the gift of the Holy Spirit in this
Dispensation of Grace (ill. Apollos Acts 18:24).
3. Paul quizzed the disciples as to what they were baptized into. vs.3
a. The word what signifies what belief, doctrine, hope, end?
b. The word unto is the Greek preposition eis denoting they entered
into some type of situation when they were baptized.
c. They disciples responded they were baptized into (literally) the result
of an act of Johns baptizing.
C. Paul points out the result of Johns baptism and three insufficiencies of that baptism
for this dispensation. vs.4
1. Johns baptism was a baptism resulting from repentance.
2. Johns baptism was to the people (Israel). (ill. Acts 4:10; 5:12,20,34; 6:8)
3. The purpose of Johns baptism was for Israel to believe on Him that
109
was to come after him (John) that He (Jesus) was the Christ.

D. Pauls baptizing of the disciples in to the name of the Lord Jesus is proof of a major
distinction that exist between the ministry of John the Baptist and belief in this
Dispensation of Grace. vs.5
1. Hearing (having heard) this.
2. They were baptized into the name (character that only He alone has
power to saveill. Acts 4:12).
3. The term Lord Jesus emphasizes one who has authority and power to
accomplish all He sets forth to do (ill. Acts 4:33; 19:13; 2 Co. 4:10)

E. The disciples received the Holy Spirit upon Paul laying his hands upon them,
which only an apostle could do. vs. 6 (ill. Acts 8:14-17)
1. The Holy Spirit came upon them (also in Acts 11:15 the key to
understanding upon and not in is the statement as He did us at the
beginning).
2. They began speaking (a quality of) tongues.
3. They began (a quality of) prophesying.

F. There were 12 men total. vs.7

G. Paul went into the synagogue at Ephesus and spoke for three months. vs.8
1. He was disputing (to converse, discourse with one, argue, discuss:
absolutely Thayer) the things concerning the Kingdom of God.
2. He was persuading (to persuade, the capacity to persuade or convince -
persuasive power, convincing ability.' .| :.tet ce|t a, 'with the
persuasive
power of (human) wisdomThayer ill. Act 28:23) the things concerning
the Kingdom of God.

H. Reception to Pauls doctrine was harsh. vs.9
1. Some in the group were hardened (to render obstinate, stubborn Thayer)
ill. Heb. 3:13; Deut. 2:30)
a. Their hardness resulted in them not believing (not to allow oneself
to be persuaded; not to comply with; a. to refuse or withhold
beliefThayer).
b. Their hardness resulted in them speaking evil (to insult in a
particularly strong and unjustified manner - to revile, to denounce.
Louw-Nida ill Matt. 15:4) of that way before the multitude.
2. Paul departed when it became apparent that he had been rejected.
a. He departed (strictly mark off by boundaries; hence separate,
sever, take away -- Friberg) from them.
b. He separated (et ,. to make a boundary; "to mark off from
(a:e) others by boundaries, to limit, to separate oneself from others,
Gal.2:12 (in this instance, from those unwilling to obey the gospel),
the disciples (those who believed), daily.
110
c. He disputed (lectured) daily in the school (a building where
teachers and students met for study and discussion - 'lecture hall,
school) of Tyrannus (A private synagogue (called beeyt midrash by
the Jews), or rather the hall of a Gentile sophist or lecturer on
rhetoric and philosophy; his name is Greek, and the "one" prefixed
implies that there was no definite leaning to Christianity in him. He
probably hired out his school when not using it himself. Paul in
leaving the synagogue would be likely to take a Gentile's hall to gain
access to the Gentiles Faussets Bible Dictionary.

I. Paul continued in Ephesus for two years. vs.10
1. All that dwelt in Asia heard the Word of the Lord Jesus.
2. The audiences included both Jews and Greeks.



II. PAUL HAD AN IMPACT ON HIS VISIT INTO EPHESUS. vs.11-22
A. God did special (of miracles extraordinary, uncommon --ill. Acts 28:2) miracles
by the hands of Paul. vs.11-12
1. Handkerchiefs or aprons from Pauls body healed diseases caused by evil
spirits.vs.12
2. The evil spirit that caused the disease departed from those touched by
handkerchiefs and aprons from Paul.

B. Other Jews tried to duplicate the miracles God was accomplishing through Paul.
vs.13
1. The term vagabond is (in order to communicate the meaning of to wander
about' or to travel about, it may be necessary to be rather specific, for
example, they first go in one direction and then in another or they first go
to one place and then off to another). ill. 1 Tim. 5:13
2. Exorcists are -one who drives out evil spirits, usually by invoking
supernatural persons or powers or by the use of magic formulas - 'exorcist,
one driving out evil spirits. Louw-Nida
3. They tried to invoke the name of the Lord Jesus as Paul had done.
a. They adjured (to demand that a person take an oath as to the truth
of what is said or as to the certainty that one will carry out the
request or command - 'to put under oath, to insist that one take an
oath, to require that one swear Louw-Nida) the demons in the
name of the Jesus that Paul preacheth
b. Those involved were the seven sons of a Jewish chief priest named
Sceva. vs.14
4. The demon had no respect for the sons of Sceva. vs.15-16
a. The demon said that he experientially knew Jesus.
b. The demon said he was acquainted (to put one's attention on, fix
one's thoughts onMk. 14:68) with Paul.
c. The demon was perplexed as to who the seven sons of Sceva were.
111
vs.15
d. The demon left the man and leaped on them. vs.16
e. The demon overcame (to bring under one's power, to subject to
oneself, to subdue, master Matt. 20:25) them.
f. The demon prevailed against them so that they:
i. fled out of the house.
ii. They were naked and wounded

C. News of the event became know to those in Ephesus. vs.17
1. The news of the event resulted in fear (emphasis is on reverential fear
ill. Lk. 7:16; Rom. 3:18) falling upon them all.
2. The news of the event caused the name of the Lord Jesus to be magnified
(figuratively, as recognizing the greatness of someone's name or reputation
extol, praise, magnify; as recognizing the importance of someone pay great
respect to, highly honorThayer).

D. Those believing turned away from the things that they were doing. vs.18-19
1. They came and confessed.
2. They showed (announced) their deeds (practices ill. Rom. 8:13).
3. Many that used curious arts (Ephesus was noted for its wizard and the
"Ephesian spells;" i.e., charms or scraps of parchment written over with
certain formula, which were worn as a safeguard against all manner of
evils. The more important and powerful of these charms were written out in
books, which circulated among the exorcists, and were sold at a great price)
brought them together and burned them before all men.
4. The amount added up to fifty thousand pieces of silver.

E. These events caused the Word of God to grow mightily (Acts 6:7; 12:24) and
prevail. (to have power; to have a power evinced in extraordinary deeds, i. e. to
exert, wield, power: Hebraistically, to have strength to overcome) vs.20

F. Paul made plans to leave Ephesus. vs.21-22
1. He was purposing (to set or to place) in his spirit to pass through
Macedonia and Achaia for the purpose of making it to Jerusalem.
2. He also planned to go to Rome after Pentecost.
3. Paul sent Timothy and Erastus ahead into Macedonia.
4. Paul remained in Asia for a season (an indefinite unit of time (the actual
extent of time being determined by the context) - 'time, period of time). (1
Co.16: 8-9)


III. THE CONVERSION OF MANY TO CHRISTIANITY CAUSED CERTAIN MEN TO
RAISE AN UPRISING AGAINST PAUL. vs. 23-41
A. The loss of wages due to the conversion of many from serving idols in Ephesus led
To no small stir (a serious disturbance - 'commotion, serious trouble. Louw-
Nida) vs.23
112

B. The main culprit leading the uprising was an entrepreneur by the name of Demetrius.
vs. 24
1. He was a silversmith (one who makes objects out of silver --especially
jewelry and fine utensils) which made silver shrines for the temple of Diana.
2. He made much money from his craft.

C. Demetrius spearheaded the uprising by agitating and organizing other craftmen.
vs.25
1. He called together the craftmen as well as other workmen of like craft.
2. His concern was that by this craft (the idols those who came to believe were
serving) we have our wealth.
3. His complaint was that Paul had: vs.26
a. Persuaded (the capacity to persuade or convince - 'persuasive
power, convincing ability Louw-Nida) many people saying that they
be no gods, which are made with hands.
b. Turned away (metanoia) many people saying that they be no gods
which are made with hands.
4. Demetrius outlines three concerns over Pauls actions: vs.27
a. Our craft is in danger to be set at nought
b. The temple of the great goddess Diana should be despised (to
convict, expose, refute; conviction, refutation, censure, repudiation
of a thing shown to be worthless).
c. The magnificence (a state of greatness or importance -
prominence, greatness, importance) of Diana should be destroyed.

D. Demetrius assertions were enough to cause tempers among the group to flare.vs.28
1. They were full of wrath (to rush along or on, be in a heat, and breathe
violently).
2. They cried out in support of Diana.

E. The dissention spread to the broader city. vs.29-33
1. The whole city was filled with confusion (disorderly mob revolt, with
special implications of uproar and disturbance - 'uproar, revolt--Louw-
Nida).
2. The capture two of Pauls traveling companions and took them into the
theatre (was anciently in the open air; semicircular; the seats in tiers
above one another the stage on a level with the lowest seats. Besides the
performance of dramas, public meetings were often in the theater, as being
large enough almost to receive "the whole city").
3. Paul desired to enter into the theatre, but many prevented it.
a. The disciples suffered him not to. vs.30
b. The chief of Asia, friends of Paul, did not permit him. vs.31
4. The majority of the crowd was confused (to pour together, to mix, to cause
such astonishment as to bewilder and dismay - 'to cause consternation, to
confound) and did not know why they were assembled. vs.32
113
a. Some cried one thing.
b. Some cried another thing.
c. The majority knew not (oida know the facts) as to why they were
assembled.
5. The Jews tried to use a certain Alexander to direct the uprising, but the
crowd rejected him because he was a Jew. vs.33-34
6. The crowd cried out for about two hours saying Great is Diana of the
Ephesians.

F. The towns clerk (a clerk, scribe, esp.a public servant, secretary, recorder, whose
office and influence differed in different states) appeased the crowd and tried to
allay their concerns. vs.35
1. The townsclerk tried to appease (to put or keep down one who is roused or
incensed, to repress, restrain, appease, quiet) the crowd by convincing them
of the widespread appeal of the great goddess Diana.
a. Ephesus was a worshipper (one who had responsibility to tend to
and to guard a temple - 'temple-keeper) of the great goddess Diana.
b. Dianas (Artemis, name of a Greek goddess) image had reportedly
fall down from Jupiter (literally-- that fell from Zeus).
2. The towns clerk emphasized Dianas credibility could not be spoken
against (not contradicted and not to be contradicted; undeniableThayer).
vs.36
a. He urged them to be quiet (to put or keep down one who is roused
or incensed, to repress, restrain, appease, quiet -- Thayer).
b. He urged them to do nothing rashly (pertaining to impetuous and
reckless behavior - 'reckless, impetuous; to calm down and not do
anything reckless as 'without thinking' or 'without counting the cost
Louw-Nida)
3. The towns clerk emphasized the illegality of the gathering.vs.37
a. The men were brought there not being robbers of churches.
b. The men were brought there not being blasphemers of your
goddess.
4. The towns clerk urged them of the proper channels available for their
charges. vs.38
a. The law is open.
b. There are deputies (proconsuls)
c. Let them implead (to call to account, bring a charge against,
accuse) one another (of the same kind).
d. He urged that if there were matters of a different concern, these also
should be taken up in a lawful assembly. vs.39
5. The towns clerk identifies the problem of their assembly. vs.39
a. All those there were in danger of being called into question for the
uproar.
i. Because there was no cause (reason or cause for an event or
state - reason, cause) for it.
ii. Because they could not give an account of this concourse (a
114
secret combination, a coalition, conspiracy).
b. The townsclerks discourse was effective in breaking up the crowd.
vs.41
Chapter 20
(A.D. 54-58)



I. PAUL DEPARTS INTO MACEDONIA AFTER THE UPROAR AT EPHESUS.
A. Paul calls the disciples together after the uproar ceased in Ephesus. vs.1
1. The word for called is (:ecsa.ca.|e,) means to send for, or to summon.
2. The term disciples probably refers to those believers that came to believe during
his time there.
3. Paul embraced (ac:a,eat to greet, to draw to ones self in embrace either in
greeting or farewell) the disciples.
4. He departed (went on a journey to accomplish a particular goal) into Macedonia.

B. Paul did not spend much time in Macedonia, but he gone over (et.O.| to travel
through, as opposed to stopping for an extended period of time ill. Acts 19:21the
second time during this trip that he passed through) those parts (different cities). vs. 2a
1. Paul gave the believers there much exhortation (:aasa. ca, to encourage, to
exhort ill. 2 Co. 9:5; 1 Th. 1:3; 2 Thess. 2:17)
2. The basis of Pauls exhortation was many words (not in King James translation).


C. Paul left Macedonia and went into Greece. vs.2b

D. Paul spent three months in Greece, and was about to depart into Syria when the Lord
prevented it. vs.3
1. Paul left Greece after certain Jews laid wait (to make a plot against ill. Acts
9:24; 23:30) for him as he was preparing to leave (perhaps to take a ship).
2. Paul purposed (,|. to decide, to have an opinion Reinecker/Rogers) to
return through Macedonia.

E. Pauls destination was Asia, but he doubled back through Macedonia in order to
reach Asia with others who accompanied him. vs.4
1. Sopater of Berea accompanied him.
2. Aristarchus and Secundus of Thessonalica accompanied him.
3. Gaius of Derbe accompanied him.
4. Timothy of Derbe accompanied him.
5. Tychicus and Trophimus of Asia accompanied him.

F. Those who organized Pauls trip went before him and waited for the group at Troas. vs.5
The chief city in the Northwest of Asia Minor, on the coast of Mysia in the Roman
province of Asia. In 133 BC Troas came into the possession of the Romans, and later,
during the reign of Augustus, it was made a Roman colonia, independent of the Roman
governor of the province of Asia. Its citizens were then exempt from poll and land tax.
115
During Byzantine times Troas was the seat of a bishopric. I.S.B.E.

G. Paul trailed from Philippi after the days of unleavened bread and arrived in Troas five days
later. vs.6
1. The days of unleavened bread (or the Passover ill. Lk. 22:1,7; Matt. 26:17; Acts
12:3)
Passover, the name given to the chief of the three great historical annual festivals of
the Jews. It was kept in remembrance of the Lord's passing over the houses of the
Israelites Ex 12:13 when the first born of all the Egyptians were destroyed. It is called
also the "feast of unleavened bread Ex 23:15; Ac 12:3 because during its celebration
no leavened bread was to be eaten or even kept in the household.
2. Paul was in Troas for seven days.


II. PAUL RAISES THE DEAD IN TROAS.
A. The disciples came together on the first day of the week. vs.7
1. First day is used to denote the day for believers assembling together in the
church, also known as the Lordian Day. (1 Co. 16:2;Rev. 1:10)
2. Paul preached unto those who gathered.
a. He continued (Pareteinen to stretch beside, to prolong) his speech until
midnight (Mk. 13:35)
b. He continued late into the night because he was preparing to leave the next
day.
3. The group gathered in the upper chamber (ill. 2 Kings 1:2; 23:12; Acts 9:37,39)
vs.8

B. Pauls extended preaching caused Eutychus to fall into a deep sleep. vs.9
1. The term sunk down with sleep is kataphero, to bear down, to drop off to sleep.
(Reinecker/Rogers describes the present tense of the verb to mean that the hot, oily
atmosphere of the lights from the torches in the upper room along with the crowd
made it difficult for one who probably put in a hard days work to keep awake)
2. He fell down from the third loft (out of the window).
3. He was taken up (picked up by those who went to him) dead.

C. Paul went to Eutychus and raised him from the dead. vs.10
1. Paul went to him and fell upon him.
2. Paul embraced him.
3. Paul insisted the believers trouble not yourself (\ Oeu.tcO. to throw into
disorder, to be troubled, to be distressed) his life (soul) is in him.

D. Paul, having raised Eutychus from the dead joined the other believers in the breaking
of bread and talking. vs.11-12
1. Breaking of bread (the Lordian Table).
2. The break of day (brightness, radiance, daylight -- ill. 2 Sam. 2:32)
3. Eutychus (a young man under the age of manhood) was brought up to the event
alive.
4. The believers were comforted (encouraged ill. Acts 15:32; 16:40).
116

E. Dr. Luke gives a narrative of the events that occurred from Troas to Miletus. vs.13-15
1. We Luke and others.
2. They sailed in to Assos where Paul had appointed (etaa cc. -- to arrange,
appoint, ordain, prescribe, give order).
3. Paul had determined to go by foot and meet them there from Troas (30 mile journey
by sea).
4. Taking Paul in at Assos, they all sailed to Mitylene.
5. From Mitylene they went the next day to Chios, then to Samos and Trogyllim where
they tarried for one day, the next day they went into Miletus. vs.15

F. Paul skips Ephesus and determines to go into Miletus. vs.16-17
1. The word determined is (to come to a conclusion in the process of thinking and
thus to be in a position to make a decision - 'to come to a conclusion, to decide, to
make up one's mind. ill. Acts 3:13; 1 Co. 2:1) to sail by Ephesus.
2. It was not Pauls purpose to spend time (to wear away time, spend time) in Asia.
3. Paul didnt want to wear away time because he hastened (to do something
hurriedly, with the implication of associated energy - 'to hasten to, to hurry to, to
do quicklyJoseph Thayer).
4. Pauls hurry was to get to Jerusalem for the Day of Pentecost, if it were possible
(he was able).
5. Paul called the elders of the church at Ephesus to meet him in Miletus in order to
save time on his way to Jerusalem. vs.17


III. PAUL GIVES FINAL EXHORTATIONS TO THE EPHESIAN ELDERS ON HIS JOURNEY
TO MILETUS.
A. Paul reviews his ministry to the elders of Ephesus. vs. 18-21
1. Paul reminds the elders of his behavior among them. vs.18
a. The word know is the Greek word e :t cac. and it us used to emphasize
primarily the knowledge obtained by proximity to the thing known; then
knowledge view as a result prolonged practice. Reinecker/Rogers (ill.
Acts
19:15)
b. The elders knew Paul-- what manner Ive been (emphasizes his
his purpose while he was with the elders of Ephesus over a period of time).
2. Paul outlines three crucial elements of the focus that he displayed while with the
elders at Ephesus. vs.19
a. Serving (metaphorically, to obey, submit to; a. in a good sense:
absolutely, to yield obedience, to obey one's commands and render to him
the services due,-- Joseph Thayer) the Lord (master).
i. With all humility of mind (the recognition of ones own weakness
as well as the recognition of Gods power Reinecker/Rogers ill.
Phil. 2:3; 1 Pet. 5:5)
ii. With tears(over the plight of saints 2 Co. 2:4).
iii. With trials (testing).
117
b. Kept (concealed) back nothing that was profitable (beneficial) unto you.
vs.20
c. Testifying (to confirm a thing by (the interposition of) testimony, to
testify, cause it to be believed Joseph Thayer) to both Jews and Greeks:
vs.21
i. Repentance (change of mind) toward God.
ii. Faith towards the Lord Jesus.

B. Paul addresses his future. vs.22-25
1. Paul was going to Jerusalem bound (bound or constrained in my spirit, i. e.
compelled by my convictions) in the spirit (human spirit) vs.21
2. Paul was going to Jerusalem not know the facts about the things what would befall
(the Greek word sunantao is a compound word made up of sun come together in
an intimate way and antao to meet the emphasis is on those things planned for
him to encounter) vs.22
3. The Holy Spirit gave Paul a general idea of what was ahead when He told him
bonds (imprisonments) and afflictions (pressures) were awaiting him. vs. 23
4. Paul assured that the things that lay ahead: vs.24a
a. Doesnt move (doesnt do anything to distract him from going there).
b. Neither did he count his life dear (of great value) unto myself.
5. Paul identified two goals that he had relative to his ministry. vs. 24b
a. Finish my course with joy.
b. Finish the the ministry I have received of the Lord Jesus (to testify of the
gospel of the Grace of God).
6. Paul had apparently been given revelation that this would be his last trip to Ephesus.
vs. 25
a. He notes that he knows (oida knows the facts).
b. No one among whom I have gone preaching the Kingdom of God would
see (to gaze at with the eyes) his face again.

C. Paul assures that he had fulfilled his responsibility to the Ephesians. vs.26-27
1. Paul claims innocence over the blood of those with whom he had preached the
gospel. vs.26-27
2. The word for explains why Paul claimed innocence from their blood. vs.27a
3. The word shunned is concealed. vs.27b
4. All the counsel (decree) of God (Lk. 7:30; Eph. 1:11) is those things
determined by the members of the Godhead in eternity past. vs.27c

D. Paul exhorts the elders to take advantage of the things he taught them so that they rake care
of Gods people. vs.28-32
1. The word therefore connects what Paul is about to say to the previous verses (18-
27). vs.28a
2. Paul lists three things the elders needed to be engaged in: vs.28b
a. Take heed means to be in a continuous state of readiness to learn of any
future danger, need, or error, and to respond appropriately - 'to pay
attention to, to keep on the lookout for, to be alert for, to be on one's guard
118
against. Louw-Nida (ill. 1 Ti.4: 16; Lk. 21:34; Matt. 16:6)
b. The pastor/teacher is supposed to first take heed to himself (doctrine and life
1 Tim. 4:16)
c. The pastor/teacher is supposed to take heed to the flock in his charge.
d. The pastor/teacher is supposed to feed (to furnish pasturage or food; to
nourish Joseph Thayer).
3. Paul was given knowledge that grievous wolves would come into Ephesus after his
departure. vs.29
a. Wolves (metaphorically, as a person with dangerous pretenses,
such as a false prophet, false teacher, or false leader vicious person, fierce
person Friberg Lexiconill John 10:10-12)
b. The adjective grievous describes the mindset of the wolves which is
violent, cruel, unsparing Joseph Thayer
c. Paul noted that these wolves would come in among you (from the outside).
d. Paul also noted that would not be ones sparing (to spare in using, to
refrain from using, use sparinglyLiddell & Scott in other words, theyll
take full advantage of the flock)
4. Paul also warns the Ephesians that trouble will arise from within. vs.30
a. Men shall arise from among the Ephesians speaking perverse (to corrupt
and so turn one aside from. (twisting the truth). Acts 13:8,10 Joseph
Thayer) things.
b. Men shall arise from among the Ephesians to draw away (to be dragged
away, detached, separated fromLiddell & Scott) disciples after
themselves.
5. In lieu of this, Paul exhorts the elders: vs.31
a. To watch (give strict attention to, be cautious, active Joseph Thayer).
b. While they were watching, Paul instructed them also to be remembering
(keep in mind) that he never ceased to warn (admonish --to provide
instruction as to correct behavior and belief - 'to instruct, to teach,
instruction, teaching).
6. Paul puts the believers in Ephesus in the hands of the Father.
a. The term commend means to place one before another for protection,
safety, etc. ill. Acts 14:23
b. Paul commended the believers to the Father. vs.32
c. Paul commended the believers to the Word of (concerning) His Grace.
i. That Word has an ability to build the believers up (make one grow
in the Christian life).
ii. That Word has an ability to give believers an inheritance (the
share, which an individual will have in that eternal blessedness
Joseph Thayer) among all them which are sanctified.

E. Paul offers his time among the Ephesians as an example of how a shepard is supposed to
behave. vs.33-35
1. He didnt covet another mans finances. vs.33
2. He worked to minister unto his necessities and others with him. vs. 34a
3. He graphically demonstrated the necessity of supporting the weak (contextually, to
119
be weak in means, needy, poorJoseph Thayer).

F. Paul gives his final farewell to the believers at Ephesus. vs.36-38
1. Paul prayed with the elders of Ephesus. vs.36
2. They fell on Pauls neck (To "fall on the neck" of a person is a very usual mode
of salutation in the East. In moments of great emotion such salutation is apt to end
in weeping on each other's neck. I.S.B.E.ill. Lk. 15:20). vs. 37
3. Their greatest source of sorrow as the words Paul spake to them that they would see
his face no more. vs.38





































120



Chapter 21
(A.D. 54-58)



I. PAUL IS WARNED TWICE BY THE HOLY SPIRIT NOT TO GO INTO JERUSALEM.
Acts 21:1-16
A. Dr. Luke narrates Paul and his entourages departure from Miletus.
1. They took a straight course (from one point to the next) into Coos (The
Greek word means "summit"; an island off the coast of Caria, Asia Minor,
one of the Sporades, mountainous in the southern half, with ridges
extending to a height of 2,500 ft.; identified with the modern Stanchio. It
was famous in antiquity for excellent wine, amphorae, wheat, ointments,
silk and other clothing.
2. The next day they traveled into Rhodes (an island to the south of the
western extremity of Asia Minor, between Coos and Patara, about 46 miles
long and 18 miles broad. Here the apostle probably landed on his way from
Greece to Syria Ac 21:1 on returning from his third missionary journey)
Easons Bible Dictionary, then into Patara (A coast city of ancient Lycia.
Because of its excellent harbor, many of the coast trading ships stopped at
Patara, which therefore became an important and wealthy port of entry to
the towns of the interior).
3. They sought a ship that crossed into Phenice, (Phoenicia, in the apostolic
age a tract of the province of Syria, situated on the coast of the
Mediterranean between the river Eleutherus and the promontory of
Carmel, some thirty miles long and two or three broad -- Joseph Thayer)
embarked on it then set fort (put out to sea).
4. They sighting Cyprus and leaving it on the left they came into Syria.
5. They left Syria going down the coast into Tyre.

B. Paul receives his first warning not to go into Jerusalem.
1. The group remained in Tyre seven days for the ship to unload (to
disburden oneself; to lay down a load, unlade, discharge: -- Joseph
Thayer) its cargo.
2. They found (a|.ut cs. --to learn the location of something by
intentional searching - 'to find by searching, to look for and find Louw-
Nida ill. Lk. 2:16) disciples (obviously Christians).
3. Those disciples warned Paul against going to Jerusalem.
a. They said (they kept on saying) to Paul.
b. They said it through (the Greek here expresses the idea of
throught
the intermediate agency of in other words, the Holy Spirit used
them to convey this message to Paul) the Spirit.
121
c. They told him not (\) to go up to Jerusalem (There are two
primary Greek words for not in Scripture).
i. 0u is the stronger of the two negatives and can be translated
it is clear-cut point-blank negative, objective, final Dana &
Mantey Greek Grammar.
ii. \ is a weaker, milder negative, denying subjectively and
with hesitancy. It leaves the question open for further remarks
or entreaty while 0u closes the door abruptly. Dana &
Mantey


C. Paul and the group left when those days were accomplished. vs.5-6
1. Some of disciples (women and children included) of that city followed them
(to the edge out of the city.
2.They all knelt upon the seashore and prayed.
3. They took leave (to say goodbye - 'to bid goodbye to, to take leave of --
Louw-Nida) and embarked into the ship.
4. The disciples returned to their own home.

D. The trip toward Jerusalem continued from Tyre (a rock, now es-Sur; an ancient
Phoenician city, about 23 miles, in a direct line, north of Acre, and 20 south of
Sidon. Sidon was the oldest Phoenician city, but Tyre had a longer and more
illustrious history. The commerce of the whole world was gathered into the
warehouses of Tyre. "Tyrian merchants were the first who ventured to navigate
the Mediterranean waters -- Eastons Bible Dictionary) into Ptolmais (a maritime
city of Phoenicia, which got its name, apparently, from Ptolemy Lathyrus, who
captured it 103 BC, and rebuilt it more beautifully). vs.7
1. They saluted the brethren.
2. They abode with them one day.

E. Pauls and his entourage departed and went into Caesarea. vs.8-9
1. They entered into the house of Philip the evangelist (one of the seven deacons
Chapter 6)
2. They abode with him.
3. He had four daughters who prophesied vs.9
a. Prophesying is generally, of speaking with the help of divine
inspiration proclaim what God wants to make known, preach,
expound; as speaking out divinely imparted knowledge of future
events foretell, prophesy; as bringing to light what was concealed
and outside the possibility of naturally acquired knowledge.
Friberg Lexicon
b. It was announced that both men and women would prophesy when the
Holy Spirit was poured out. Acts 2:17-18.
c. Men and women prophesied in the early Church. 1 Co. 11:5.
d. Prophecy edifies the Body. 1 Co. 14:3,5
4. Paul and his entourage abode with Phillip many days. vs.10
122

F. Paul is warned again, this time by the prophet Agabus (with a graphic illustration),
not to go into Jerusalem. vs.10
1. Agabus took Pauls girdle (belt, serving not only to gird on flowing
garments, but also, since it was hollow, to carry money in J oseph Thayer
Acts 21:11)
2. Agabus bound (tied) his own hands and feet (Symbolic of how God
revealed future events to Israel in the Old Testament Jer. 13:1-11; Act
21:33)
3. Agabus asserted that the Holy Spirit warned: vs.11
a. The man to whom the girdle belonged will in like manner be bound by
the Jews at Jerusalem.
b. The man to whom the girdle belonged would be delivered into the
hands (authority) of the Gentiles.

G. The disciples gathered at Phillips house and those in Pauls entourage responded
with concern when they heard the prophecy.vs.12-13
1. Hearing the prophecy, they besought (kept on begging) him not to go up
to Jerusalem.
2. Paul answered the disciples:
a. What mean ye to weep and break my heart (A frequent equivalent
of 'to break one's heart' is 'to cause one to cry.' In some languages
one may even have 'to cause one's heart to cry. Louw Nida)
b. He was ready to be bound in Jerusalem for the name of the Lord
Jesus.
c. He was ready to die at Jerusalem for the name of the Lord Jesus.

H. Paul refused to be influenced by the pleas of the disciples. vs.14
1. He was in a continual state of not to be persuaded. (:.t .: to convince
someone to believe something and to act on the basis of what is
recommended - 'to persuade, to convince Louw-Nida) ill. Matt. 27:20;
Acts 12:20; 1Co. 2:4
2. The disciples ceased (cu,a ,. -- to keep quiet; to rest, cease from
labour; to lead a quiet life, said of those who are not running hither and
thither, but stay at home and mind their business; to be silent, i.e. to say
nothing, hold one's peace) their plea.
3. The disciples the will of the Lord be done.

I. Paul and his entourage left Caesarea and Phillips house and went into Jerusalem.
vs.15-16
1. We took up our carriages (having gathered and made ready the things
necessary for the journey).
2. They went up to Jerusalem.
3. Some of the disciples from Caesarea accompanied Paul and his entourage.
a. Manson of Cyprus was one of the disciples from Caesarea
accompanying them.
123
b. Manson was an old (pertaining to having existed for a long time in
the past, with the possible implication of such existence from the
beginning of an event or state - 'for a long time, from the beginning,
ancient) disciple



II. PAUL GIVES A REPORT ON HIS THIRD APOSTOLIC JOURNEY TO THE CHURCH
AT JERUSALEM. Acts 21:17-20a
A. Pauls entry into Jerusalem was cordial, initially. vs.17
1. They were received (welcomed) by the brethren in Jerusalem.
2. They were received with gladly (pertaining to experiencing happiness,
implying ready and willing acceptance).

B. Paul and his entourage met with James and the elders of Jerusalem the next day.
vs.19
1. He greeted them.
2. He declared (to draw out in narrative, unfold in teaching; a. to recount,
rehearse Joseph Thayer ill. Lk. 24:35; Acts 15:12) to them what things
(each thing) God wrought (did) among the Gentiles through his ministry.

C. James and the elders responded favorably to Paul report before addressing a
concern running rampant among the Church in Jerusalem. vs.20
1. They glorified (to cause the dignity and worth of some person or thing to
become manifest and acknowledged Joseph Thayer) (the) God. ill Acts
4:21; 11:18; 13:48
2. They then addressed the issue of Paul teachings about the law. vs.20b



III. PAULS ATTEMPT TO APPEASE THE JEWS LEADS TO AN UPROAR THAT
LANDS HIM INTO JAIL. vs.21-40
A. They addressed three issues: vs.20c
1. Thousands of Jews believed (to think to be true; to be persuaded of; to
credit, place confidence inJoseph Thayer) and were all zealous (to
defend and uphold a thing, vehemently contending for a thing)
of the law.
2. They were informed (to inform by word of mouth; passive to be orally
informed i.e the word on the street) that Pauls teaching on his
apostolic journeys encouraged Jews to forsake (falling away, defection,
apostasy; in the Bible namely, from the true religion J oseph Thayer).
a. That he teaches all the Jews which are among the Gentiles that they
ought not to circumcise their children. vs.21a
b. That he teaches all the Jews which are among the Gentiles neither to
walk after the customs (a pattern of behavior more or less fixed
by tradition and generally sanctioned by the society). vs.21b
124
3. What should happen when at the events of the feast the zealots hear that Paul
is in Jerusalem. vs.22

B. James and the elders at Jerusalem take the lead in instructing Paul on a course of
action that they think will appease the Judiazers. vs.23-24
1. They informed him to do therefore this thing.
2. Paul was to take four men who had a vow (Num. 6:18; Acts 18:18):
a. He was to take (to take with oneself, to join to oneself) them and
be purified (to take upon oneself a purification, and is used of
Nazarites or those who had taken upon themselves a temporary or a
life-long vow to abstain from wine and all kinds of intoxicating
drink, from every defilement and from shaving the head). ill. Num.
6:3 together with them.
b. He was to be at charges (ea:a|a .: to pay out money (or other
assets) as a means of obtaining benefits or in payment for benefits
'to spend, to pay out, to pay expenses) with them that (for the purpose
that) they might shave their heads. (Numb. 6:13-21)
3. The purpose of this action was that all may know(experientially): vs.24b
a. The things they are informed concerning thee are nothing
(absolutely, nothing whatever, not at all, in no wisethat Paul,
even at that time, had been observing the law as proved by the vow)
ill. Acts 24:17
b. Contrarily, though walkest (keep in step) keepest (guards) the
law.
4. Their plan concerning Pauls relationship to the Gentiles was to have him
follow the conclusions reached by the first council at Jerusalem. vs.25
a. That they keep themselves from idols.
b. That they keep themselves from things strangled and blood.
c. That they keep themselves from fornication.

C. Paul adheres to the directives of James and the elders. vs. 26
1. He took the men and the next day purifying himself together with them.
2. He entered into the temple:
a. To signify the accomplishment of the days of purification.
b. Until an offering should be offered for every one of them.

D. James and the elders instruction did not prevent the Jews from attacking Paul. vs.27
1. The waited until the seven days of purification had ended. vs. 27a
2. The Jews of Asia stirred (to disturb, the mind of one, to stir up to tumult
or outbreak, to confound or bewilder -- Joseph Thayer ill. Acts 2:6; 9:22)
up the people (Israel) when they saw him in the temple.
3. They laid hands (cast) upon him.
4. They cried out for help from other Jews saying: vs.28
a. This is the man that teacheth all men everywhere against the
people (Israel).
b. This is the man that teacheth all men everywhere against the law
125
c. This is the man that teacheth all men everywhere against this place.
d. He brought Greeks into the temple and has profaned (to cause
something to become unclean, profane, or ritually unacceptable - 'to
make unclean, to defile, to profane Louw-Nida ill. Ez. 44:6-9) the
holy place.
i. The last accusation was made because they had seen
Trophimus which was an Ephesian, together with Paul in the
city.
ii. They supposed (to regard something as presumably true,
but without particular certainty - 'to suppose, to presume, to
assume, to imagine, to believe, to think) since they saw them
together in the city that he had brought him into the temple.

E. The accusation of defiling the temple caused an uproar. vs. 30
1. The whole city was moved (to throw into commotion) ill. Acts 24:5.
2. The people ran together (to throw into commotion, to come together
quickly to form a crowd - 'to rush together, to run together, to assemble
quickly Louw-Nida).
3. They took Paul.
4. They dragged (pull or drag, requiring force because of the inertia of the
object being dragged - 'to pull, to drag, to draw Louw-Nida) him outside
the temple.
5. The doors were shut.

F. Those who captured Paul were seeking to kill him until the chief captain arrived. vs.
31

G. The chief captain responded quickly to squelch the uprising. vs.32-33
1. He took soldiers and centurions and ran down () to them.
2. The Jews left (ceased) beating (to strike or hit an object, one or more
times - 'to hit, to strike, to beat) of Paul when they arrived.
3. He took Paul and:
a. Bound him with two chains.
b. Demanded (inquired as to) who he was.
c. Demanded (inquired as to) what he had done (per.tense).

H. The chief captain got a varied response from Jews. vs.34a
1. Some (of the same kind) cried (to speak with considerable volume or
loudness - 'to cry out, to shout, to call out, to speak loudly) one things.
2. Some (of the same kind) cried another.

I. The chief captain realized the futility of gathering information within the mob.vs.34b
1. He was not able to know the certainty (a state of knowledge certain,
reliable, sure; as what is certain or definite the truth, the facts) because of
the uproar.
2. He commanded him to be taken into the castle (the barracks of the
126
Roman soldiers, which at J erusalem were in the castle Antonia).

J. The crowd was in such a vicious state of mind to get Paul the soldiers had to take
extra precautions to protect him. vs.35-36
1. He was borne (to take up in order to carry or bear; to put upon oneself
(something) to be carried) of the soldiers for the violence of the people.
2. The multitude of the people followed crying away (to take from
among the living, either by a natural death, or by violenceJoseph
Thayer) ill. Matt. 24:39; Luke 23:18; John 19:15; Acts 21:36) with him.

K. Paul requested of the chief captain an audience with the chief captain. vs. 37
1. He made the request as he was led into the castle.
2. The chief captain was still bent on finding out who Paul was.
a. He assumed he was an Egyptian rebel who had led an uproar in the
desert. vs.38
b. Paul introduced himself to the chief captain. vs.39
i. He informed him that he was a Jew.
ii. He informed him that he was from Tarsus no mean city
(pertaining to being obscure or insignificant, with the
possible implication of lacking in noble descent - 'low,
insignificant, inferior. pertaining to being obscure or
insignificant, with the possible implication of lacking in
noble descent - 'low, insignificant, inferior --- Louw-Nida)

iii. He request the opportunity to speak (to make known one's
thoughts, to declare; to say) to the people.

L. The chief captain gave Paul permission to speak to the crowd. vs.40
1. Paul stood on the stairs.
2. Paul beckoned with the hand unto the people.
3. A great silence was made when he began speaking to them in the Hebrew
tongue.














127



Chapter 22




I. PAUL OFFERS A DEFENSE TO THE JEWS FOR HIS PREACHING AMONG THE
GENTILES.
A. The word for defense in verse 1 is the word apologia (defense; as a legal technical term,
a speech in defense of oneself reply, verbal defense Friberg Lexicon)
. 1. Paul was given by the Lord to give a defense for Christianity. Phil. 1:17
a. At his first defense, none of his companions stood by him. 2 Tim. 4:16
b. He gave a defense before Felix. Acts 24:10
c. He gave a defense before Festus. Acts 25:8
d. He gave a defense before Agrippa. Acts 26:2,24
2. Believers are told to give a defense when one asks. 1 Pet. 3:15

B. Paul spoke to them in the Hebrew tongue (dialect, which is the form of speech
characteristic of a nation or region dialect, language, way of speaking) in
order to reach the Jews.
1. The term tongue is the same one used to denote speaking in tongues. Act 2:6,8
2. Speaking to them in the Hebrew tongue caused the Jews to keep the more silence
(cu,ta -- as characterized by inward calm tranquillity, quietness) vs.2

C. Paul offers his Jewish roots as proof #1 to justify his preaching among the Gentiles. vs. 3-5
1. Paul addressed his origin. vs.3
a. He himself was a Jew.
b. He was born in Tarsus, a city of Cilicia.
c. He was brought up in Jerusalem at the feet of Gamaliel (The son of rabbi
Simeon, and grandson of the famous rabbi Hillel. He was a Pharisse, and
therefore the opponent of the party of the Sadducees. He was noted for his
learning, and was president of the Sanhedrim during the regins of Tiberius,
Caligula, and Claudius, and died, it is said, about eighteen years before the
destruction of J erusalem Easton Bible Dictionary)
d. He was taught according to the perfect manner (exactness, minute
accuracy, precision, with minuteness or precision, -- Liddell & Scott ill.
Acts 26:5 Matt. 2:8) of the law of the fathers (what belongs to or is
derived from one's father or ancestors paternal, inherited, ancestral
Friberg Lexicon).
e. He was zealous toward God (like the rest of the Jews ill. Act 21:20; Gal.
1:14; Rom. 10:2) up to that time.
2. Paul addressed his disdain for the Christians at the beginning. vs.4
a. He persecuted (to follow with haste, and presumably with intensity of
effort, in order to catch up with, for friendly or hostile purpose - 'to run
128
after, to chase after, to pursueLouw-Nida ill. Acts 26:11; Gal.1: 13; 1 Co.
15:9) them unto the death.
b. He persecuted them binding and delivering into prisons(men and women).
3. Paul provided witnesses who could attest to his prior attitude towards Christianity.
vs.5
a. The high priest (a principal priest, in view of belonging to one of the
high priestly families - 'chief priest Louw-Nida)
b. All the estate of the elders (group of elders functioning with
administrative authority body or council of elders; in J erusalem equivalent
to the Sanhedrin, the J ewish high court as a Christian church council
presbytery, group of elders Friberg Lexicon) who gave him letters (a
message, command, commission, whether verbal or in writing) unto the
brethren to bring them bound from Damascus to Jerusalem to be punished.

D. Paul offers his encounter with the Lord as proof #2 to justify his preaching among the
Gentiles. vs.6-13
1. It was on the road to Damascus that Paul had an encounter with the Lord. vs.6
a. He encountered the Lord as he made (proceeded on) his journey and was
near Damascus.
b. Paul stated that suddenly (unexpectedly, out of nowhere) saw a light (a
heavenly light, such as surrounds angels when they appear on earth and
illumines the place where they appear Joseph Thayer).
i. The light occurred about noon time.
ii. The light came from (the preposition ek out of) the heaven
(presence of the article indicates the origin of the light to be from the
throne room of God).
iii. The light shined round about (denotes giving out light with
lightning like quality; transitively shine around someone) him.
c. Pauls reaction to the light was to fell unto the ground (ground, soil, land).
vs.7a
d. As Paul was on the ground he heard a voice asking why he was persecuting
Him. vs.7b
e. Paul inquired as to whom was speaking to him. vs.8
i. The term Lord is used in Scripture for a polite address as well as
master.
ii. Jesus (the One who came to save Israel from their sins Matt. 1:21)
of Nazareth emphasized the one whom people rejected in his
humanity.
2. Paul indicated that his traveling companions were not privy to the conversation. vs.9
a. They saw (to behold, look upon, view attentively, contemplate --- Lk.
23:55) the light.
b. They were afraid (because of the light)
c. They heard not the voice.
3. Paul was given directive as to what he was to do. vs.10
a. He was to go into Damascus.
b. He was instructed that he would be told all things which are appointed (to
129
assign someone to a particular task, function, or role - 'to appoint, to
designate Louw-Nida) for him to do.
4. Paul adhered to the Lords directions. vs.11
a. Looking at the glory blinded Paul vs.11
i. He was not able to see (to direct one's vision and attention to a
particular object - 'to look straight at, to look directly at Louw-
Nida)
ii. His vision was hindered because of the glory (Gods opinion as
manifested in light) Heb. 1:3; 2 Pet. 1:17) of the light.
b. Paul was led by the hand of them that were with him into Damascus.
5. God provided Ananias to help Paul. vs.12-13
a. Ananias was a devout man (dedicated in the things according to the law
ill. Lk.2: 25). vs.12
b. Ananias had a good report (testimony) of all the Jews with were in
Damascus. vs.13
c. Ananias came unto me to Paul.
d. Ananias restored Pauls sight (the same hour).

E. Paul offers his destiny as proof #3 to justify his preaching among the Gentiles. vs.14
1. Ananias offered two reasons for Pauls encounter with the Lord.
a. God of our fathers chose him that he should know His will.
i. The fathers mentioned here are the 12 sons of Israel (Jacob).
ii. The word chose means to designate beforehand. ill. Acts 10:41.
iii. The word know is ginomai and should be translated, to come to an
experiential knowledge of.
iv. The term for will is those things that God wishes to be done by us
Joseph Thayer Rom. 12:2; Co. 4:12
b. God chose him that he should:
i. See the Just One.
ii. Should hear the voice of His mouth.
iii. To be a witness unto all men of (the things) he saw and heard. vs.15
2. Ananias instructed Paul as to his next actions: vs.16
a. Be baptized.
b. Have thy sins washed away (by) calling upon (to appeal to one, make
appeal unto Joseph Thayer) the Name (character) of the Lord. (ill. 1 Co.
6:11; 1:2)
3. The Lord appeared to Paul when He went into Jerusalem subsequent from leaving
Damascus. vs.17
a. The Lord appeared to Paul in the temple.
b. Paul saw the Lord while he was in a trance (Friberg --as an abnormal state
of mind distraction, terror, amazement; as a partially suspended conscious
nessecstasy, trance) Acts 10.10
4. The Lord instructed Paul to leave Jerusalem. vs.18
a. Make haste is better translated get out quickly.
b. The Lord instructed Paul as to why he was to leave Jerusalem.
i. Paul was told to leave Jerusalem because they would not receive.
130
(welcome; to admit i. e. not to reject, to accept, receive Joseph
Thayer) Mark 4:20; Acts 16:21
ii. Paul was informed that what they wouldnt receive was his
testimony (see verse 15) concerning the Lord.
5. Paul was hesitant to leave Jerusalem thinking his background in persecuting
Christians would be sufficient justification to the Jews. vs.19-21
a. He said they know (understand; to turn oneself or one's mind to, put
one's thought upon a thing Joseph Thayer) how he persecuted those that
believed on the Lord. vs.19
b. He said that they know that he consented(to be pleased at the same time
with, consent, agree to 2a) to applaud Joseph Thayer) unto the death of
Stephen. vs.20
c. The Lord ignored Pauls pleas and sent him far hence unto the Gentiles.
vs.21


II. PAULS DEFENSE DID NOT PERSUADE THE JEWS TO BELIEVE HIM.
A. The Jews listen to him until he mentioned the Gentiles. vs.22
1. Gave him audience means to attend to (use the faculty of hearing), consider what
is or has been said Joseph Thayer.
2. They responded vehemently against Pauls assertion.
a. Away means to take up or take away. ill. Lk. 23:18
b. It is not fit (proper).

B. The Jews responded violently to Pauls assertion. vs.23
1. They cried out.
2. They cast off their clothes (tore their garments).
3. They threw dust into the air a symbolic of renunciation, as we would say
"washing one's hands of him," an intimation that all further intercourse was at an
end. I.S.B.E

C. The Roman captain responded to the uprising by taking Paul in for further examination.
1. He commanded Paul be taken into the castle. vs.24a
2. He resorted to examining Paul by scourging so that he might know why the Jews
had such a disdain for him. vs.24b
Note on scourging --A Roman implement for severe bodily punishment.
Horace calls it horrible flagellum. It consisted of a handle, to which several
cords or leather thongs were affixed, which were weighted with jagged pieces of
bone or metal, to make the blow more painful and effective. The victim was tied to a
post (Acts 22:25) and the blows were applied to the back and loins, sometimes even,
in the wanton cruelty of the executioner, to the face and the bowels. In the tense
position of the body, the effect can easily be imagined. So hideous was the
punishment that the victim usually fainted and not rarely died under it. Eusebius
draws a horribly realistic picture of the torture of scourging. By its application secrets
and confessions were wrung from the victim. It usually preceded capital
punishment. It was illegal to apply the flagellum to a Roman citizen, since the Porcian
and Sempronian laws, 248 and 123 BC, although these laws were not rarely broken in
the provinces. I.S.B.E.
131

D. Paul relied upon his Roman citizenship to avoid an unwarranted beating. vs.25
1. They bound (stretch or spread out) him with thongs.
2. As they were binding him Paul asked a question of the centurion that stood next to
him whether it was lawful (predominately as denoting that an action is not
prevented by a higher court or by law it is permitted, it is lawful, it may be done) to
scourage a man who is a Roman who was uncondemned (pertaining to not
having gone through a judicial hearing, with the implication of not having been
condemned - 'without trial Louw-Nida). vs.25

E. The centurion alerted the chief captain to take heed, that Paul was a Roman. vs.26

F. The chief captain quizzed Paul about his Roman citizenship.
1. He asked Paul if he was a Roman. vs.27
Note on Roman citizenship: availed for him not in one city only, but throughout
the Roman world and secured for him everywhere certain great immunities and
rights. Precisely what all of these were we are not certain, but we know that, by
the Valerian and Porcian laws, exemption from shameful punishments, such as
scourging with rods or whips, and especially crucifixion, was secured to every
Roman citizen; also the right of appeal to the emperor with certain limitations.
This sanctity of person had become almost a part of their religion, so that any
violation was esteemed a sacrilege. Yet Paul had been thrice beaten with rods, and
five times received from the Jews forty stripes save one (2 Cor 11:24,25). Perhaps
it was as at Philippi before he made known his citizenship (Acts 16:22,23), or the
Jews had the right to whip those who came before their own tribunals. Roman
citizenship included also the right of appeal to the emperor in all cases, after
sentence had been passed, and no needless impediment must be interposed against
a trial. Furthermore, the citizen had the right to be sent to Rome for trial before
the emperor himself, when charged with capital offenses (Acts 16:37; 22:25-29;
25:11). I.S.B.E

2. The captain offered that citizenship could be purchased. vs.28
a. With a great sum
b. I obtained (acquire, get or prucure a thing for oneself Joseph Thayer)
this freedom.
c. Paul informed the captain that he was free-born (born a Roman).
3. They ceased preparing Paul for scourging. vs.29a
4. The chief captain was afraid (literally made to fear) because he had bound him.
vs.29b

G. Being stripped of scourging as a means for arriving at an answer for the Jews hatred of
Paul, the chief captain resorts to assembling the two sides in a trial.
1. He wanted (determined) to know for certainty (the facts) as to why he was
accused (to bring serious charges or accusations against someone, with the
possible connotation of a legal or court context - 'to accuse, to bring charges) by
the Jews. vs.30a
2. He loosed him from his bands.
3. He commanded the Jewish leaders to appear before him.
132
a. The Jewish leaders included the chief priests (According to the Mosaic law
no one could aspire to the high priesthood unless he were of the tribe of
Aaron, and descended moreover from a high priestly family; and he on whom
the office was conferred held it till death. But from the time of Antiochus
Epiphanes, when the kings of the Seleucid and afterward the Herodian
princes and the Romans arrogated to themselves the power of appointing the
high priests, the office neither remained vested in the pontifical family nor
was conferred on anyone for life; but it became venal, and could be
transferred from one to another according to the will of civil or military
rulers. Hence, it came to pass, that during the one hundred and seven years
intervening between Herod the Great and the destruction of the holy city,
twenty-eight persons held the pontifical dignity). I.S.B.E.

b. The Jewish leaders included the all their council. (The Sanhedrin was, at
and before the time of Christ, the name for the highest Jewish tribunal, of 71
members, in Jerusalem, and also for the lower tribunals, of 23 members, of
which Jerusalem had two. It is derived from Grk: sun, "together," and Grk:
hedra, "seat."). -- I.S.B.E.
c. He set Paul before (among) them.



























133



CHAPTER 23



I. PAUL DEFENDS HIMSELF AGAINST THE CHARGES OF THE JEWS BEFORE THE
SANHEDRIN.
A. Paul revealed to the council that he had a good conscience concerning the
doctrine that he was preaching. vs.1-5
1. The term earnestly beholding is the word atenias which means to fix
one's eyes on some object continually and intensely - 'to look straight at, to
stare at, to keep one's eyes fixed on. Louw-Nida (ill. Acts 14:9--- possibly
gazing for the purpose of gaining perception of a situation as he addressed
them) vs.1a
2. The council was the Sanhedrin (a local J ewish tribunal; the ecclesiastical
court of the J ews Abbott & Smith) vs.1b
3. A good conscience is one that doesnt bother the believer due to the fact
that he is living up to Gods standard over and above knowledge that is
inconsistent with Gods rule of life... (ill. 1 Pet. 3:21; 1 Ti. 1:19)
vs.1c
a. The good conscience Paul held was before (facing) God.
b. The good conscience Paul held was even held to up to the time Paul
was speaking to the Sanhedrin.
4. The term smite meant to strike, smite, beat (with a staff, a whip, the fist,
the handJoseph Thayer) vs. 2 (ill. Matt. 5:39; Luke 12:45)
5. Paul responded uncharacteristically to the event. vs.3
a. He charged (the one who instructed him to be smitten) to be a white-
washed wall i.e. a hypocrite. Ill. Matt. 23:27
b. The basis of Pauls charged was that the command to strike him was
contrary (to act contrary to established custom or law, with the
implication of intent - 'to disobey, to break the law, to transgress,
disobedience Louw-Nida) to the law. ill. Matt. 15:2
6. Paul was rebuked for his reviling (to reproach, rail at, revile, heap abuse
upon)Joseph Thayer) the high priest. vs.4 (ill. John 9:28; 1 Cor. 4:12; 1
Pet. 2:23)
a. Paul acknowledged that he was unaware that He was speaking to the
high priest.
b. It was against the law to speak evil (kakws) against the ruler of
Israel. ill. Ex. 22:28

B. Paul sought to divide the members of the Sanhedrin over the question of the
resurrection of Christ (probably a result of his perception gained when gazing at the
Sanhedrin). vs.6-10
1. The word perceived (ginosko gained an experiential knowledge)
134
a. He perceived that part of the Sanhedrin were Pharisees.
b. He perceived that part of the Sanhedrin were Sadducees.
2. Paul exploited a point of contention between the two groups. vs. 6
a. He cried out that he was being judged due to the hope of the
resurrection from the dead.
b. Pauls contention caused a dissension (politically taking a stand,
especially a rebellious insurrection, uprising, revolt; as sharp
dissension or unrest within a community strife, heated quarrel,
conflict. between the two groups. vs.7 (ill. Acts 15:2)
c. The dissension developed into a division (to be split into factions,
be divided) ill. Matt. 27:51; Acts 14:4
d. The Sadducees did not believe in the resurrection, angels or spirit.
vs.8a
e. The Pharisees confessed both. vs.8b
3. Those from among the Pharisees joined Pauls side due to the possibility that
a spirit or an angel could have spoken to him. vs.9a
a. They strove (etaa ,eat to fight or contend with, involving
severity and thoroughness - 'to protest strongly, to contend with
LouwNida)
b. They concluded to find no evil (kakos) in this man. vs.9b
4. The dissention over the matter increased to the point the chief captain
feared for Pauls life. vs.10
a. He feared that Paul was going to be pulled in pieces (to pull or tear
an object apart LouwNida) ill. Mk. 5:4
b. He ordered his men to go down and by force (harpazo the word
for rapture, to seize or to snatch) him and take him into the castle.

C. The Lord appeared to Paul to reassure him of the things that he was suffering. vs.11
1. He told Paul to be of good cheer (a term of assurance given by our Lord to
encourage believers facing trouble) ill. John 16:33
2. Paul was assured that he was to bear witness (for all the apostolic
instruction came back finally to testimony respecting things which they
themselves had seen or heard, or which had been disclosed to them by
divine revelationJoseph Thayer)of the (things concerning) the Lord in
Rome as he had at Jerusalem. (Acts 1:21;5:32; 10:41)


II. THE JEWS QUEST TO KILL PAUL CONTINUED.
A. They banded together (a twisting up together, a binding together. b. a secret
combination, a coalition, conspiracyJoseph Thayer) in a plot to kill Paul. vs.12-
15
1. They placed themselves under a curse (to invoke divine harm if what is
said is not true or if one does not carry out what has been promised -to
curse.Joseph Thayer)
2. The curse include them neither eating or drinking until the pledge to kill Paul
was fulfilled. vs. 12
135




B. Pauls nephew gained knowledge of the plot. vs.16-21
1. Paul nephew heard of the plot, possibly from information being passed
around the word akouo is used here to denote to be informed of something
being passed around Friberg Lexicon.
2. Upon hearing the information, Pauls nephew entered to into the castle where
Paul was being held to inform him. vs.16
3. Paul instructed that his nephew be taken to the chief captain to report the plot.
vs.17
4. The term for young man is one beyond the age of puberty, but normally
before marriage Louw-Nida (this context probably denotes one closer to
puberty than the latter -- ill. Mk. 14:51) vs.18
5. The word for asked denotes to inquire, ask, question; learn (by inquiry)
Barclay-Neuman vs.19
6. They agreed is the Greek word cu|t t as coming to a mutual
understanding agree together, come to an agreement with someone; as
coming to a mutual decision within a group Friberg Lexicon and is used in
Lk. 22:5 of Judas agreeing together with the chief priests and captains about
betraying Jesus. vs.20

C. The chief captain in an attempt to thwart the plot prepared to send Paul out of the
city by stealth to Felix the governor. vs.22-24
1. The chief captain charged Pauls nephew not to let anyone know that he had
disclosed the plot to him. vs.22
2. The chief captain made plans to move Paul in the dark of night. vs.23
a. He called for 200 soldiers who would take Paul to the edge of
Caesarea.
b. He called for 70 horsemen (soldiers who fight on horseback, or the
calvary) who would escort Paul from Caesarea onward.
c. He called for 200 spearman (soldiers whose duty it was to guard
captives bound by a chain on the right hand, they were experts with
the lance -- Thayer)
d. He called for the plan to commence at the third hour (a day is seen
in New Testament time as involving sunrise to sunset 12 hours ill.
John 11:9 the third hour was presumably the time of sunset).
3. Two reasons are given for the chief captains actions:
a. That they may set (by most definitions to be placed upon a horse,
his means of traveling i.ehorse, camel) Paul.
b. That they might bring him safe (to rescue completely from danger
Friberg Lexicon) to Governor Felix.
Note on the governors of the Roman empire: A governor was an
official in the Roman empire administering a province in
136
the name and with the authority of the Roman emperor
they held the power to judge matters in the Roman empire. (ill.
Matt. 27:13-14)





III. THE CHIEF CAPTAIN OUTLINES THE CRUX OF THE ISSUE BETWEEN PAUL
AND THE JEWS (AS HE HAD ASCERTAINED) IN A LETTER TO THE GOVENOR.
A. The chief captain embellishes his role in the rescue of Paul vs. 27-28
1. He accurately writes that Paul was taken (seized) by the Jews. vs.27a
2. He accurately writes that he was about to be killed (to get rid of someone
by execution, often with legal or quasi-legal procedures - 'to kill, to execute
Louw Nida) vs.27b
3. He stretches the truth when he said that he rescued him because he was a
Roman. (see Acts 22:23-24) vs. 27c
4. The phrase would have known is better rendered and determining to
experientially know the cause wherefore they accused (as a legal
technical term (formal) charge, ground for accusation Friberg Lexicon)
him (so that he could bring charges) I brought him forth into their council.
vs.28

B. The chief captain surmised that the problems that the Jews had with Paul were
concerning questions of their law. vs. 29
1. He found that the Jews charges were based upon questions (debates ill.
Acts 26:3) concerning their law.
2. He found that the Jews charges were not worthy (befitting, congruous,
corresponding, to a thing) of death or of bonds.

C. The chief captain justified his actions for sending Paul to the governor. vs. 30
1. He determined to send Paul to him when it was made known to him that a
plot was made to kill Paul.
2. He gave commandment to his accusers to make their charges to him (Felix).

D. The governor consented to hear the case against Paul. vs. 31-35
1. Antipatris was a city situated between Joppa and Caesarea, in a very fertile
region, not far from the coast. vs.31
2. The soldiers delivered Paul to Felix and returned to the castle.vs.32-33
3. The governors inquiry into what province Paul was from was due to the
fact that a province one derived from signified a magistrate's sphere of
administrative action (I.S.B.E.).
4. The term judgment hall is the word for the palace in which the governor
or procurator of a province resided, to which use the Romans were
accustomed to appropriate the palaces already existing, and formerly dwelt
in by the kings or princes (in this case, Herods).
137




CHAPTER 24


I. THE JEWS PROVIDE A SPOKESMAN TO MAKE THEIR CASE AGAINST PAUL
BEFORE FELIX.
A. The Jews brought forth the dream team of the Sanhedrin to make their case
against Paul:
1. Ananias was high-priest in Jerusalem from 47-59 AD. He was nominated to
the high-priestly office by Herod of Chalcis. In 52 AD he was sent to Rome
by Quadratus, legate of Syria, to answer a charge of oppression brought by
the Samaritans, but the emperor Claudius acquitted him. On his return to
Jerusalem, he resumed the office of high priest. He was deposed shortly
before Felix left the province, but continued to wield great influence, which
he used in a lawless and violent way. He was a typical Sadducee, wealthy,
haughty, unscrupulous, filling his sacred office for purely selfish and political
ends, anti-nationalist in his relation to the Jews, friendly to the Romans.
I.S.B.E.
2. Tertullus was the main prosecutor against Paul, he was a hired pleader whose
services were necessary that the case for the Jews might be stated in proper
form. Although he bore a Roman name, he was not necessarily a Roman;
Roman names were common both among Greeks and Jews, and most orators
were at this time of eastern extraction. Nor is it definitely to be concluded
from the manner of his speech (Acts 24:2-8) that he was a Jew; it has always
been customary for lawyers to identify themselves in their pleading with their
clients. I.S.B.E.
3. The term orator is the Greek word ee, from which we get our English
word rhetoric. I.S.B.E. defines the term thusly --The word "orator" occurs
twice: (1) As the King James Version rendering of Heb: lachash; only Is. 3:3
the eloquent orator," the King James Version margin "skilful of speech,"
where the Revised Version (British and American) rightly substitutes "the
skillful enchanter." The word Heb: lachash is probably a mimetic word
meaning "a hiss," "a whisper" and is used in the sense of "incantation"
"charm." Hence, Heb: nebhon lachash means "skillful in incantation,"
"expert in magic.

B. Tertullus skill at rhetoric is exemplified in his currying up to Felix. vs. 2-4
1. He commended Felix due to the much peace obtained by the Jews (Dia
thorough the instrumentality of Felix in other words Felix had helped the
Jews to exist as a nation within the confines of the Roman empire). vs.2
2. The term very worth deeds is the word ete.a.|.
a. di through
b. orQw setting straight
138
c. Used in composition the word means what has been set straight,
especially internal improvements in administration reformFriberg
Lexicon.
d. Those worthy deeds were done for Israel through Felix
providence (forethought--to think about something ahead of
time, with the implication that one can then respond appropriately
- 'to give attention beforehand, to have in mind to do Louw-Nida)
3. Tertullus expresses the thanksgiving the Jews have for Felix reforms. vs.3
4. Tertullus begs for patience from Felix. vs.4
a. The term further tedious is egkopto which means 'to knock in' or
'to incise,' not occurring in the NT) to use strong measures in
causing someone not to do something - 'to prevent, to hinder, to
stop someone from.' Louw-Nida
b. I pray thee is to ask for forbearance.
c. A few words is used to denote a relatively brief period of time,
implying some measure of reduction or shortening - 'briefly, in a
short time.'Louw-Nida

C. The crux of the Jews case against Paul was four-fold:
1. He was a pestilent (widespread contagious disease, often associated with
divine retribution - 'plague, pestilence used that way of diseases in
Scripture --ill. Lk. 21:11; Rev. 11:6). vs.5a
2. He was a mover (onewho cause to go, i. e. to move, set in motion; to
excite, to throw into commotion Joseph Thayer) of seditions (divisions)
among all the Jews. vs.5b
3. He was a ringleader (one stationed in the front ranks of an army leader
Friberg Lexicon) of the sect (the word is the term heresy which Christian
was described as early on by the Jews ill. Acts 28:22) of the Nazarenes. vs.
5c
4. He had gone about to profane (to cause something to become unclean,
profane, or ritually unacceptable - 'to make unclean, to defile Louw-Nida)
the temple. vs.6

D. The Jews desired to attend to Paul themselves, but was thwarted from this purpose.
vs.6b -9
1. We took (.saca.| -- to lay hold of, take, seize: t|a, to lay hands on
one in order to get him into one's power -- Joseph Thayer) indicates that
the Jews believed it was in their power to deal with Paul themselves.
2. Note: verse seven and the first part of verse eight is not in the better
manuscripts.
3. Verse eight should read: By examining of whom thyself mayest take
knowledge of all these things were of we accuse him. vs.8
a. Tertullus contended that Felix could find out the facts by examining
(to investigate, examine, inquire into, scrutinize, sift, question
Joseph Thayer ill. Acts 17:11; Lk. 23:14)
b. Tertullus was certain that Felix examination would produce a
139
experiential knowledge of the things of which the Jews were accusing
Paul.
4. The Jews that accompanied Tertullus consented that the things he presented
were so.vs.9

II. PAUL GIVES HIS DEFENSE BEFORE FELIX.
A. Paul was optimistic of his chances before Felix because of his experience in dealing
with matters concerning the Jews. vs.10
1. Felix had been a judge (of a Roman procurator administering justice
Joseph Thayer) to the nation.
2. Paul know (or better read, was acquainted with the fact) that Felix
had much knowledge of Israel due to his administration of justice
concerning them over the years and was glad that it was he that he had an
opportunity to give his answer (apologoumaidefense).

B. Paul refutes the accusations made by the Jews. vs. 11-13
1. Argument #1 for Paul was that it had been only 12 days since he went to
Jerusalem to worship. vs.12
a. The Jews during that time period did not find him in the temple
disputing (to converse, discourse with one, argue, discuss:
absolutely, --Joseph Thayer) with anyone.
b. The Jews during that time period did not find him in the temple or
elsewhere raising up (bringing together, gathering (as of fruits),
a contracting; an assembling together of men Friberg Lexicon)
the people.
2. Argument #2 focused on the fact that the Jews could not (they dont have
an ability) to prove (legally prove, show to be true -- Friberg Lexicon)
the things in which they accused Paul. vs.13

C. Paul contends that his teaching was not inconsistent with Judaism. vs. 14-16 (note:
this argument by Paul proves that God did promise something different to Israel than
he did to the Church and belief in Christianity does not nullify the hope of the Jews
had concerning those promises).
1. Paul states that he worshipped the God of the fathers (of Israel):
a. He worshipped (the word latreuw means to do priestly service ill.
Rom. 12:2) them after (according to a standard of measurement
of) that way
b. Pauls worship according to the way did not hinder his believing
(of the credence given to God's messengers and their words, with a
dative of the person or thing Joseph Thayer) all the things which
are (better understood according to) written in the law. 1 Co.
14:21; Lk. 10:26; 2:23
c. Pauls worship according to the way did not hinder his believing the
things written in the prophets. ill. John 6:45; Lk. 4:17; 20:17; Matt.
2:5
2. Paul asserts to Felix that his belief in the way doesnt affect the hope that
140
he has concerning Israel:
a. Paul expected a resurrection of the dead just. Dan. 12:2 (ill. Matt.
13:49; Lk. 14:14)
b. Paul expected a resurrection of the dead unjust. Dan. 12:2
3. Pauls conscience was proof that the promises made to Israel and the
way were not inconsistent with Gods plan and purposes. vs.16
a. The term herein is better translated by this thing (the hope of the
resurrection of the just and unjust). vs. 16a
b. Pauls hope of the resurrection allowed him to exercise (do one's
best to, strive to, exert oneself to Frieberg Lexicon) a conscience
void of offense (denotes a conscience that is pertaining to being
blameless in view of not having given offense - 'blameless, without
blame. not striking against or stumbling; metaphorically, not led
into sin; blameless ill. 1 Co. 10:32) vs.16b

D. Paul explains his actions on the day in question. vs. 17-21
1. His intent was to bring alms (to give to those in need as an act of mercy
'acts of charity, alms, giving to the needyLowaNida ill. Acts 3:2;
10:4) to Israel. vs.17a
2. His intent was to bring offerings (that which is offered, a gift, a present
Joseph Thayer) ill. Heb. 10:18 vs.17b
3. Jews from Asia found Paul: vs.18
a. Purified (ceremonially: to cleanse themselves from levitical
pollution by means of prayers, abstinence, washings, sacrifices); the
passive has a reflexive force, to take upon oneself a purification,
John 11:55; Acts 21:24) in the temple.
b. Neither with multitude (noise or clamor marked by confusion
'clamor, noiseill. Acts 21:34)
c. Nor with tumult (a casual collection of people; a multitude of men
who have flocked together in some place Joseph Thayer ill. Matt.
27:24; Acts 19:33)
4. Paul asserted that it was those Asian Jews who should have brought charges
against him, if they had charges to bring. vs.19-20
5. Paul stated that the only possible charge could have been his statement
concerning the resurrection from the dead. vs.21

E. Felix delayed action on the matter while awaiting the appearance of the chief-captain
and his testimony. vs.22-23
1. Felix postponed a decision until he was able to more accurately gain a
knowledge concerning that way. vs.22a
2. He awaited the arrival of Lysias, the chief captain to know (to obtain
accurate and thorough information about - 'to learn about accurately, to
get detailed information, to examine thoroughlyLouw--Nida) the things
concerning Paul. vs.22b
3. Felix commanded a centurion keep (guard) Paul. vs.23a
141
4. Felix commanded Paul be allowed liberty (to let loose, slacken, anything
tense, e. g. a bow, a loosening, relaxing; spoken of a more tolerable
condition in captivity: to be held in less rigorous confinement; have
indulgenceJoseph Thayer). vs.23b
5. Felix commanded Paul not be forbidden none of his acquaintance to
attend (serve) him. vs.23c


III. PAUL GIVES A REASONED DEFENSE TO FELIX CONCERNING HIS FAITH IN
JESUS CHRIST.
A. Felix and his wife Drusilla set before Paul to hear his argument. vs.24
1. Drusilla was a daughter of Agrippa the elder, wife of Felix, the governor of
J udaea, (a most licentious woman) per Josephus. vs.24a
2. Felix sent (to send after for oneself, cause to be sent for: -- Joseph Thayer)
for the purpose of satisfying Drusilla who was acquainted with Judism, be a
Jewess. vs.24b
3. He heard Paul concerning the faith into Christ Jesus. vs.24c

B. Paul reasoned (ill. Acts 19:8; 20:9) with Felix and his wife over a number of
topics related to Christianity:
1. Righteousness. ill. John 16:8
2. Temperance. Ill. 1 Co. 9:25
3. The judgment to come. Rev. 20:11-12

C. Pauls message had a traumatic effect upon Felix. vs.25
1. Pauls message made Felix afraid (terrified, startled, afraid Friberb
Lexicon -- ill. Lk. 24:5; Acts 10:4) vs.25a
2. Felix sent Paul away promising to send for him at a later date. vs.25b

D. Felixs corruption led him to attempt to make financial gain from Pauls situation.
vs. 26-27
1. Felix had hoped that Paul would pay him money to get out of prison so he
sent for him often and communed (to associate with; to stay with; hence,
to converse with, talk with Joseph Thayer). vs.26
2. Felix, being the consummate politician left Paul in jail after Porcius Festus
came into office to earn a favor to the Jews. vs.27










142




CHAPTER 25



I. FESTUS PLAYS POLITICS WITH PAULS IMPRISONMENT TO GAIN FAVOR FOR
HIMSELF WITH THE JEWS. VS. 1-12
A. Festus rejects the Jews desire to kill Paul without a hearing. vs.1-5
1. A province was in the most comprehensive official sense it signified a
magistrate's sphere of administrative action, which in one instance might
be the direction of jurisdiction at Rome, in another the management of
military operations against a particular hostile community. I.S.B.E. vs.1
2. The term informed denotes to report or declare a thing against a person,
to inform against one. Joseph Thayer vs.2
3. The high priest and the Jewish leaders besought (the word means they
begged him it is in the imperfect tense denoting that they started begging
him with the result that they continued to do so a sign of desperation of
getting Paul out of the judicial loop so they could attend to him themselves).
a. They desired favor (a benefit showed someone with the implication
that it would be reciprocated in some way) against Paul. ill. vs.9
b. The request was for Festus to summon Paul into Jerusalem so that the
Jews would ambush him along the way and kill him. vs.3
4. Festus answered (was madeto answer passive voice denotes it possibly
was because of Roman protocol) that Paul would remain in Caesarea. vs.4a
5. Festus assured that he was headed to Ceasarea shortly (without delay, at
once, speedily)
6. Festus urged those who were able among the Jews to travel together with him
to Ceasarea if they had accusations to make against Paul. vs.5

B. Festus spends time in Jerusalem before returning to Caesarea. vs 6.
1. Contrary to his statement to the Jews that he was going quickly to
Caesarea, Festus tarried (etat . to remain or stay in a place, with the
implication of some type of activity Louw-Nida) ten days among them
(Jews in Jerusalem).
2. Festuss tarrying among them possibly had some effect in his actions of verse
9.
3. After 10 days Festus goes down into Ceasarea and sits upon the judgment
(ae, -- a raised platform mounted by steps and usually furnished with a
seat, used by officials in addressing an assembly, often on judicial matters -
'judgment seat, judgment place.' The association of a a with judicial
procedures means that there is almost always an important component of
judicial function associated with this term. Therefore in translating a, it is
143
often best to use a phrase such as 'a place where a judge decides' or 'a place
where decisions are made) seat. ill. Matt. 27:19; Acts 18:16-17

C. The Jews lodged their complaint before Festus. vs. 7
1. The Jews stood round about (to stand around someone or to encircle
Louw-Nida)
2. The Jews made many grevious (of important matters very significant,
serious, momentous Friberg Lexicon) complaints.
3. The Jews were could not (t c,ue| -- to have special personal ability to do
or experience something - 'to be able to, to have the strength to, to be very
capable of. Louw Nida) prove (to prove by arguments, demonstrate).

D. Paul refuted the Jews charges in his defense. vs.8
1. Paul asserted that he had done nothing against the law of the Jews.
2. Paul asserted that he had done nothing against the temple.
3. Paul asserted that he had done nothing against Caesar.

E. Festus plays politics with Pauls imprisonment. vs.9
1. Festus desiring (Qelw wishing) to do the Jews a favor.
2. Festus ask Paul if he was desiring to go up to Jerusalem to be judged before
him. (This was contrary to what he had told the Jews upon their request for
this very thing. vs.3

F. Paul is led to take his appeal over the head of Festus directly to Caesar. vs.10-12
1. Paul assert that it was at Caesars judgment seat (Bhmatoj) in which he
stood where it was necessary (according to Roman protocol not in
Jerusalem under Jewish law) him to be judged.
2. Paul asserted to Festus that he hadnt done wrong (to wrong some one, act
wickedly toward him J oseph Thayer) to the Jews. ill. Acts 7:26; 2 Co. 7:2
3. Paul was sure that Festus knew (epiginowskw) this and thus concluded that
he would get no justice before this man.
4. Paul made it clear to Festus that he thought his actions were not in keeping
with what was proper under Roman law. vs.11a
a. He assured Festus that he didnt refuse (beg, ask that something not
take place Frieberg Lexicon) to die if he had done some wrong
worthy of death.
b. Paul reasoned that if (rather, since) there be none of these things
(worthy of death), no man (not even Festus, under Roman law) has
(has the ability) to deliver (,at,eat to give or grant graciously
and generously, with the implication of good will on the part of the
giver - 'to give, to grant, to bestow generously Louw-Nida) me to
them.
5. Paul asserted his right as a Roman citizen to appeal (epikalew to call
upon or to invoke ones name) to Caesar. vs.11b

Note: Appeals under the Roman Empire were made by Roman citizens
144
who were sent to Rome might be brought either before the senate or
emperor, but cognizance of these cases by the imperial tribunal was
more usual, and finally supplanted entirely that of the senate, the
formula of appeal becoming proverbial: cives Romanus sum, provoco ad
Caesarem (Kaisara epikaloumai: Acts 25:11).
As Roman citizenship became more and more widely extended
throughout the empire its relative value diminished, and it is obvious
that many of the special privileges, such as the right of trial at Rome,
which were attached to it in the earlier period must have been gradually
lost. It became customary for the emperors to delegate their power of
final jurisdiction over the lives of citizens (ius gladii) to the provincial
governors, and finally, after Roman citizenship had been conferred upon
the inhabitants of the empire generally by Caracalla, the right of appeal
to Rome remained the privilege of certain classes only, such as senators,
municipal decurions (Digest xlviii.19, 27), officers of equestrian rank in
the army, and centurions.
6. Festus conferred (talk, converse, discuss with Friberg Lexicon) with the (Jewish)
council before pronouncing he would send Paul on to Caesar. vs.12



II. FESTUS COMMENDS PAULS CASE TO KING AGRIPPA FOR EXAMINATION.
VS.13-27
A. Agrippa had received a royal education in the palace of the emperor himself. But he
had not wholly forgotten his people, as is proven by his intercession in behalf of the
Jews, when they asked to be permitted to have the custody of the official highpriestly
robes, till then in the hands of the Romans and to be used only on stated occasions.
On the death of his uncle, Herod of Calchis, Claudius made Agrippa II "tetrarch" of
the territory, 48 AD. As Josephus tells us, he espoused the cause of the Jews
whenever he could. Four years later (52 AD), Claudius extended the dominion of
Agrippa by giving him the old "tetrarchies" of Philip and Lysanias. Even at Calchis
they had called him king; now it became his official title. Still later (55 AD), Nero
added some Galilean and Perean cities to his domain. vs.13a

B. Bernice was the daughter of Herod Agrippa the elder. She married first her uncle
Herod, king of Chalcis, and after his death Polemon, king of Cilicia. Deserting him
soon afterward, she returned to her brother Agrippa, with whom previously when a
widow she was said to have lived incestuously. Finally she became for a tithe the
mistress of the emperor Titus. vs.13b

C. Felix wife Drusilla was Agrippa and Bernice sister (Acts 24:24).

D Agrippa and Bernice arrived in Caesarea to salute (pay one's respects to, of those
who show regard for a distinguished person by visiting him Joseph Thayer)
Festus. vs.13c

145



III. FESTUS EXPLAINS PAULS CASE TO AGRIPPA.
A. Festus declared (as setting forth one's cause declare, refer to (for counsel)
-- Friberg Lexicon) Pauls case to Agrippa. vs.14a

B. Festus explains that he was left behind (it is used of one whom on being called
away cannot take another with him. Acts 24:27; 25:14; specifically, of the dying
Joseph Thayer). vs.14b

C. Festus explained that the Jews in Jerusalem desired judgment (to judge someone
as definitely guilty and thus subject to punishment - 'to condemn, to render a
verdict of guilt, condemnation. Louw-Nida) against him. vs. 15

D. Festus informs Agrippa of his response to the Jews.
1. He said he told them it was not the custom (a pattern of behavior more or
less fixed by tradition and generally sanctioned by the society - 'custom,
habit Louw-- Nida) of Rome to give one over for destruction until face to
face accusations are made. vs.16
2.A defense was also necessary before rendering a judgment. vs.16

E. Festus states that this was why he order Paul to be held captive and his accusers to be
brought before the judgment seat with their charges. vs.17

F. The Jews accusations were not such that Festus had supposed (to have an opinion
based on scant evidence, often with the implication of regarding a false opinion as
true - 'to imagine, to conjecture, to suspect, to falsely suspect, to be suspicious
Louw-Nida). vs.18-19
1. The Jews accusations included questions concerning their own
superstitions (a set of beliefs concerning deity, with the implication of
corresponding behavior - 'religion -- Louw-Nida).
2. The Jews accusations included questions concerning Jesus whom Paul
affirmed (to speak about something with certainty - 'to declare, to assert.
--Louw-Nida) to live.

G. Festus asserts that he doubted ("to be without resources, to be in straits, to be left
wanting, to be embarrassed, to be in doubt, not to know which way to turn --
Joseph Thayer) such manner of questions. vs.20
1. Festus claims that it was this doubt that led him to ask Paul to go to
Jerusalem to be judged by him. (this is contrary to the insight Scripture
gives for why he asked Paul to go to Jerusalem vs.9)
2. Festus claims that it was Pauls appeal to Caesar that led him to not send
Paul to Jerusalem. vs.21

H. Agrippa determined (the imperfect voice denotes that he made up his mind before
146
Festus concluded his explaination that he wanted to hear Pauls defense). vs.22

I. Agrippa and Bernice came into the auditorium with great pomp (imagination, the
power by which an object is presented (|at |.at) to the mind the object presented
being |a |aca Liddell & Scott). vs.23 (ill. Heb. 12:29)
1. Members of the military hierarchy were present.
2. High ranking city officials were present.

J. Festus explained to those gathered the Jews desire for Pauls death. vs.24

K. Festus acknowledges Pauls innocence. vs.25

L. Fetus asked for Agrippa to examine (as a law-term among the Greeks, the
preliminary investigation held for the purpose of gathering evidence for the
information of the judges Friberg Lexicon) Paul in order that he might have
something to write Caesar concerning Paul. vs.26

M. Festus thought it unreasonable (denotes with out thinking, absurd, without
reason) to send Paul to Caesar without a charge to signify (make clear) the
crimes against him. vs. 27


























147


CHAPTER 26



I. KING AGRIPPA GIVES PAUL PERMISSION TO ANSWER HIS ACCUSERS. vs. 1-3
A. Agrippa permits (.:t. :.at -- to allow someone to do somethingLouw-
Nida) ill. 1 Tim. 2:12
1. Agrippa permits Paul to speak.
2. Pauls speech was to be for thyself (on behalf of ones self).

B. Paul indicates his happiness with appearing before Agrippa.
1. Paul said the think (denotes to consider, regard) himself happy. ill. Phil.
3:7
2. The basis of Pauls happiness was that he could answer the Jews accusations
before (epi - before) you.

C. Paul had knowledge of the fact that Agrippa was an expert in matters concerning the
Jews.
1. Paul knew Agrippa was an expert (one who knows, with the usual
implication of to know well - 'one who knows, expert. LouwNida) in all
the things of the Jews. ill. John 18:15,16
a. Agrippa was an expert in all the customs (fixed pattern of behavior
habit, custom, usage; plural morals, habits, characterFriberg
Lexicon) ill. John 19:40
b. Agrippa was an expert in the questions (debates) of the Jews. ill.
Acts 23:29
2. Consequently, Paul begged Agrippa to hear him patiently (long-
sufferingly) ill. Lk. 18:7


II. PAUL GIVES AN ACCOUNT OF HIS FORMER LIFE. vs.4-12
A. The term Paul uses for life in this context is bios life, which is to conduct oneself,
with focus upon everyday activity - 'to live, daily life, life, existence Louw Nida.
vs. 4 ill. 1 John 2:16
1. Paul asserted that the Jews were familiar with his conduct from my youth,
or rather, from his boyhood since he was a boy.
2. Paul asserted that his conduct took place in and among the Jews.

B. Paul asserted that the Jews had foreknowledge of his life as a Pharisee. vs.5

C. Paul states that he is on trial: vs.6
1. For the hope (evp .:t et upon the basis of an expectation).
2. The hope was derived from the promise made by God to the fathers (of
Israel) That the Christ would be raised from the dead. ill. Acts 13:33; Lk.
148
24:46; Ps. 2:2

D. Paul identifies that is the hope of the resurrection of Messiah that the Jews serving as
priests (night and day), are hoping to arrive (of what comes to a person or
community come to, reach; happen to, befall Louw-Nida vs.7 ill 1C o.10.11

E. Paul questions Agrippa as to why it is so incredible (unbelievable) that God raises
the dead. vs.8

F. Paul revealed that he too once shared the Jews thinking concerning the name of Jesus
of Nazareth. vs.9
1. He had thought it necessary to do contrary (opposed as an adversary,
hostile, antagonistic in feeling or act Joseph Thayer) ill. 1 Thess. 2:15
2. The term do is the word prasso, which means to carry out some activity
(with possible focus upon the procedures involved) - 'to do, to carry out, to
perform, deed LouwNida)

G. Paul chronicles his pursuits of believers before his conversion.vs.10-11
1. He shut saints up into prison.
2. He gave his voice (|e|---since in the ancient courts of justice the
accused were condemned by black pebbles and acquitted by white Paul
raised black pebbles against Christians) against them.
3. Paul states that he punished (to punish, with the implication of causing
people to suffer what they deserve Louw-Nida) them often.
4. Paul states that he compelled (to necessitate, compel, drive to, constrain,
whether by force, threats, etc., or by persuasion, entreaties, etc., or by other
means Louw Nida) them to blaspheme.
5. Paul was exceedingly mad (:.tcc., .at|e .|e, -- to be so furiously
angry with someone as to be almost out of one's mind - 'to be enraged, to be
infuriated, to be insanely angry).


III. PAUL GIVES AN ACCOUNT OF HIS CONVERSION. vs.12-15
A. Paul explains that it was on his way to Damascus to persecute saints that the had an
encounter with the Lord. vs.12
1. At midday (a position in the middle of an area either an object in the
midst of other objects or an area in the middle of a larger area Louw-
Nida) he saw a light out from heaven. vs.13
a. The light was above the brightness (radiance-- in a number of
languages a clear distinction is made between some objects, which is
bright in and of itself (that is to say, the source of brightness or
radiance) and objects which are bright because they reflect light
from some source Louw-Nida) of the sun.
b. The light was shinning round (to illuminate an area surrounding
an object Louw-Nida) about Paul and those who journeyed with
him.
149
2. Paul heard a voice after he had fallen to the ground. vs.14
a. The voice spoke to Paul in the Hebrew tongue (language).
b. The voice inquired of Paul as to why he was persecuting Him.
c. The personal pronoun Me indicates the union the believer shares
with the Lord as a member of His Body.
d. Kick against the pricks was a familiar proverb in both
Greek and Latin literature, and refers to the severer goading
received by an ox, which kicks back at the goad used to guide
or urge him on. The words seem to mean that Paul's
paroxysm of persecution was a painful as well as profitless
resistance to the pricks of conscience by which God was leading
him into the light. I.S.B.E.
3. Paul enquired as to whom it was that was calling him. vs.15


IV. PAUL GIVES THE BASIS FOR HIS ACTIONS FOLLOWING HIS CONVERSION.
vs.16-18
A. The Lord pointed out two reasons for His appearance to the apostle Paul: vs.16
1. To make (to choose for a particular purpose in advance - 'to choose in
advance, to select beforehand, to designate in advance Louw-Nida). ill.
Acts 3:20; 10:41
2. The word minister is hupertees which means is from u:e, and .. , from
.. cc. to row; properly, an under rower, subordinate rower; anyone who
serves with his hands; a servant Joseph Thayer (The word is also used to
denote one who sets the pace for an endeavor ill. Acts 13:5; 1 Co. 4:1)
3. The term witness denotes one who declares facts directly known to
himself; from firsthand knowledge or from firsthand experience. Friberg
Lexicon
a. Paul was to be a witness of the things, which he saw (of visions
during sleep or ecstasy -- Joseph Thayer ill. Rev. 1:19)
b. Paul was to be a witness of the things, which he would see in future
appearances by the Lord.

B. God promised Paul deliverance from the Jews and the Gentiles. vs.17

C. The Lord explained to Paul that He would send him to the Gentiles. vs. 18
1. To open (with a figurative sense, literally open the eyes of the mind, i.e.
cause to understand Friberg Lexicon) their eyes.
2. To turn them from darkness to light.
3. To turn them from the authority of Satan to God.
a. The purpose was that they might receive forgiveness of sins.
b. The purpose was that they might receive an inheritance among the
saints.



150
V. PAUL GIVES AN ACCOUNT OF GODS EXPECTATIONS FOR MANKIND. vs 19-.20
A. Paul states to Agrippa that as a result of the things he heard, he was not disobedient
to the heavenly vision (an event in which something appears vividly and credibly
to the mind, although not actually present, but implying the influence of some
divine or supernatural power or agency Louw-Nida ill. 2 Co. 12:1) vs.19

B. Pauls message to those in Damascus, Jerusalem and among the Gentiles was two-
fold: vs.20
1. Repentance (have a change of mind) for the purpose of turning to the
(true) God.
2. Do (practice) works meet (befitting of, consistent with) repentance.


VI. PAUL GIVES AN ACCOUNT OF THE PURPOSE OF CHRISTS INCARNATION.
vs.21-24
A. Paul asserts that the aforementioned was the reason that the Jews sought to kill him.
vs.21

B. Paul credits God with helping him to deliver the message that was consistent with
the prophets and Moses. vs.22-23 (ill. Lk. 24:27; Dt. 18:15; Ps. 22; Is. 53)
1. The Messiah would suffer.
2. The Messiah would be first (first in a series involving time, space, or set
-- Louw-Nida) to be raised out from the dead. (ill. 1 Co. 15:20-23)
3. The Messiah would proclaim light to the people (Israel).
4. The Messiah would proclaim light to the Gentiles.

C. Festus balks at Pauls assertion of the resurrection from the dead. vs.24
1. Festus accused Paul of being beside thyself (to think or reason in a
completely irrational manner - 'to not be in one's right mind, to be insane,
to be mad, to be out of one's mind, insanity, madness.Louw-Nida).
2. Festus attributed Pauls manical behavior to his much learning (of
education letters, learningFriberg Lexicon) ill. Jn 7.15

D. Paul refutes Festus claim that he was mad. vs.25
1. Paul states that his words are truth.
2. Paul states that his words are of a soberness (a mind reflectively thinking
on salvation) frame of mind. ill. 2 Tim. 1:7


VII. PAUL APPEALS TO AGRIPPAS KNOWLEDGE OF THE JEWS. vs. 26-32
A. Paul leans on Agrippas familiarity with the matters discussed to legitimize his
premis.
1. Paul stated that Agrippa knows (the word here is not oida to know the
facts, but .:t caat which means to possess information about, with the
implication of an understanding of the significance of such information
to be aquainted with a person or thing. ill Acts 19:15) vs.26a
151
2. Paul stated that the things he spoke of had not hidden (a|a |. to cause
oneself to not be known, with the implication of concealment and secrecy
'to escape notice, to remain hid- den. the kings notice. vs.26b
3. Paul stated that the things he spoke of was not done in a corner (a
reference to something, which was not done in secret)

B. Paul asserts that his acquaintance with the fact of Agrippas belief in the Old
Testament prophets. vs. 27
1. The word know is oida, which means to know the facts. Paul had some
information that Agrippa did believe the prophets of Israel.
2. Believe is the word :tc.u. believe (in), have faith (in) (with God or
Christ as object); believe, believe in; have confidence (in someone or
something), entrust (something to another) Barclay/Neuman ill. Ja.2: 19

C. Agrippa quizzed Paul as to whether he thought he could persuade him to be a
Christian in a little while (such short time). vs.28

D. The phrase would to God is better translated .| et,. sat .| :e., in a little
while or in much time. vs.29

E. Agrippa and the other high-ranking officials departed at Pauls last statement. vs.30

F. Agrippa, Festus and others discussed Pauls case when after they departed from his
midst.
1. When they had gone aside is the Greek word a|a,.. . -- to move away
from a location, implying a considerable distance - 'to withdraw, to retire,
to go off, to go away. Louw Nida. They talked between themselves (one
another of the same kind).
2. In the conference held between the officials they concluded:
a. Paul had not done anything worthy of death.
b. Paul had not done anything worthy of imprisonment.

G. The sovereignty of God is manifested in Agrippas last statement to Festus in that
God allowed the circumstances where Paul would appeal to Caesar. vs.32
1. This many might have been set free (You had the power in the past to
release this man)
2. The If (.t -- except) he had not appealed to Ceasar.









152


CHAPTER 27

I. PAUL EMBARKS ON HIS TRIP TO ROME TO MAKE HIS APPEAL TO CAESAR.
A. It was determined that the best course to Italy was by sail. vs.1a

B. Paul was delivered over to a Roman centurion for vs.1b

C. Adramyttitum (An ancient city of Mysia in the Roman Province of Asia. When
Pergamus became the capital of Asia, Adramyttium grew to be a city of
considerable importance, and the metropolis of the Northwest part of the province.
There the assizes were held. The coins which the peasants pick up in the
surrounding fields, and which are frequently aids in determining the location and
history of the cities of Asia Minor, were struck at Adramyttium as late as the 3rd
century AD, and sometimes in connection with Ephesus. Upon them the effigies of
Castor and Pollux appear, showing that Adramyttium was the seat of worship of
these deities. -- I.S.B.E.the ship was from this city) was vs.2a

D. Aristarchus of Thessonalonica accompanined Paul and Dr. Luke. vs.2b
Note: Aristarchus was one of those faithful companions of the apostle Paul who shared with
him his labors and sufferings. He is suddenly mentioned along with Gaius as having been
seized by the excited Ephesians during the riot stirred up by the silversmiths (Acts 19:29).
They are designated "men of Macedonia, Paul's companions in travel." We learn later that
he was a native of Thessalonica (Acts 20:4; 27:2). They were probably seized to extract from
them information about their leader Paul, but when they could tell nothing, and since they
were Greeks, nothing further was done to them.
When Aristarchus attached himself to Paul we do not know, but he seems ever after the
Ephesian uproar to have remained in Paul's company. He was one of those who accompanied
Paul from Greece via Macedonia (Acts 20:4). Having preceded Paul to Troas, where they
waited for him, they traveled with him to Palestine. He is next mentioned as accompanying
Paul to Rome (Acts 27:2). There he attended Paul and shared his imprisonment. He is
mentioned in two of the letters of the Roman captivity, in the Epistle to the church at Col
(4:10), and in the Epistle to Philem (1:24), in both of which he sends greetings. In the former
Paul calls him "my fellow-prisoner." According to tradition he was martyred during the
persecution of Nero. I.S.B.E.

E. Paul was not treated as an abject prisoner by his centurion guard. vs.3
1. He courteously entreated (of acting in a humane manner kindly, in a
friendly wayFriberg Lexicon) Paul. vs.3a
2. He gave him liberty (to turn to, transfer, commit, entrust.
-- Joseph Thayer) to go to his friends and refresh (be cared for, get
needed care--Friberg Lexicon) himself.

F. Pauls trip was detoured from their way because of contrary (literally, of direction
opposite; substantively . .|a|t a, opposite, over against someone (MK 15.39); of
the wind contrary, blowing against -- Friberg Lexicon) winds. vs.4 ill. Matt. 14:24

G. Paul sails as far as Lycia before the centurion puts them on a ship to Italy. vs. 6
153
1. They went through Cilicia and Pamphylia in to Myra.
2. The ship they caught was a ship of Alexandria (one of the great corn fleet
carrying grain from Egypt for the multitudes of Rome. (After the capture of
J erusalem the emperor Titus returned to Italy in such a vessel, touching at
Rhegium and landing at Puteoil.) The size of the vessel is indicated by the
fact that there were 276 persons on board, crew and passengers all told
(Acts 27:37). Luke has made no note of the name of this or of the previous
vessels in which Paul had voyaged. Of the presumably larger vessel, also an
Alexandrian corn ship bound for Rome, which had wintered in Melita, and
which afterward took on board the shipwrecked partyI.S.B.E.

H. The ship of Alexandria faced difficulties along the journey. vs.7
1. The wind did not suffering (permitting) them to continue their course.
2. Due to the contrary winds, they sailed into Crete.
3. Hardly passing (to sail past, coast along Joseph Thayer) they arrived in a
play called Fair Havens (FairGood; Havens Harbor --a relatively small
area of the sea which is well protected by land but deep enough for ships to
enter and moor - 'harbor). vs.8
4. Much time was spent (a considerable time having elapsed) vs.9a
5. Sailing became dangerous (insecure, unsafe; of a voyage in stormy seas -
hazardous, dangerousFriberg Lexicon) vs.9b
6. Paul intervened and to give the captain some advice due to the dangerous
conditions. vs.9c
a. He did so because the fast (the tenth of the month Tisri: Acts 27:9
(the month Tisri comprises a part of our September and October (cf.
B. D. under the word month (at end)); the fast, accordingly,
occurred in the autumn, when navigation was usually dangerous on
account of storms -- Joseph Thayer) was already past.
b. He admonished (:aat|. .: to indicate strongly to someone what
he or she should plan to do - 'to advise strongly, to urgedLouw-
Nida) them.
7. The context of Pauls admonition included: vs.10
a. He perceived O...t| is used primarily not of an indifferent
spectator, but of one who looks at a thing with interest and for a
purpose; ...t| would be used of a general officially reviewing or
inspecting an army, . acat of a lay spectator looking at the
parade. ...t| as denoting the careful observation of details --
Joseph Thayer that the voyage would end in hurt and much
damage(to suffer the loss of something which one has previously
possessed, with the implication that the loss involves considerable
hardship or suffering --Louw-Nida.
b. Paul perceived that the lading would be damaged.
c. Paul perceived that the lives of those aboard would be affected.
8. The centurion believed the master (one who commands a ship - 'captain of
a ship --Louw-Nida of the ship over Paul. vs.11
9. The haven was not commodious (not convenient, not commodious, not fit:
154
The season for navigation in those seas in ancient times was from April to
October. During the winter the vessels were laid up, or remained in the
shelter of some suitable haven. The reason for this was not simply the
tempestuous character of the weather, but the obscuration of the heavens
which prevented observations being taken for the steering of the ship -
Joseph Thayer/I.S.B.E.) to winter in and one part advised to depart from
that location. vs.12
a. The hope was that they might attain to Phenice and winter there.
b. Phenice was a haven of Crete.


II. THE APOSTLES VESSEL ENDURES A GREAT STORM THAT GOD USES TO
BRING GLORY TO HIMSELF.
A. The ships captains decision to leave Fair Havens turns out to be a bad one. vs.13
1. They supposed (to regard something as presumably true, but without
particular certainty - 'to suppose, to presume, to assume, to imagine, to
believe, to think) they had obtained their purpose when the south wind blew.
2. They loosed (to draw up anchors from the bottom of the sea) sailing close
by Crete.
3. A tempestuous (Expressions for strong winds often differ on the basis of
two important features: (1) the strength or violence of the wind and (2) the
duration of the wind. For example, in English terms such as squall and
tornado indicate violent but short periods of blowing, while hurricane or
typhoon indicates a storm which takes a much longer period of time to pass.
LouwNida) wind arose after they set sail. vs.14
a. The wind was called Euroclydon (from Eue, the southeast wind,
and su e.| a wave), a southeast wind raising mighty waves
Joseph Thayer)
b. The ship was caught (to seize by force and carry awayJoseph
Thayer) vs.15a
i. The ship could not bear (a|e|a.. strictly look in the
face; hence, of a ship against the wind bear up against, face
intoFriberg Lexicon) up into the wind.
ii. The captain let her drive (were borne along ill. 2 Pet. 1:21)
4. The ship ran under (u:e.,. -- to sail or move along beside some object
which provides a degree of protection or shelter - 'to sail under the shelter
of; to sail on, protected by Louw--Nida) an island called Claudia. vs.16a
5. The ship had much work to come by the boat (we were scarcely able to get
the boat under control Louw--Nida). vs. 16b
a. The ship was taken up vs. 17a
i. Helps (a nautical technical term for safety devices for a
ship supports, such as ropes Friberg Lexicon) were used to
undergird the ship.
ii. They struck sail fearing getting stuck in the quicksand
(Syrtis, the name of two places in the African or Libyan Sea
between Carthage and Cyrenaica, full of shallows and
155
sandbanks, and therefore destructive to shipsFriberg
Lexicon).
iii. The ship was driven as a result of setting sail.
b. The ship continued to suffer so that the ships captain took extreme
measures. vs.18
i. The ship was exceedingly tossed (c|ee. ,: a very high point
on a scale of extent and in many contexts implying
vehemence or violence - 'exceedingly, greatly, violently,
terrible)
ii. The ship was tossed by a temptest (to afflict with a tempest,
to toss about upon the waves)
iii. The next day they lightened (.ta| to throw, to hurl) the
ship.
iv. The third day they cast out the tackling (gear, presumably
spare sails and tackle) off the ship. vs.19

B. The uncertainty of the outcome began to have an effect upon the occupants of the
ship. vs.20
1. Neither sun nor stars appeared for many days. vs.20a
2. No small temptest (stormy or rainy weatherReinecker/Rogers) lay
upon (to lie upon or over, rest upon, be laid or placed upon; of the
pressure of a violent tempest) the ship for many days. vs. 20b
3. All hope of salvation was taken way (as a nautical technical term, of an
anchor lift, raise cut off, cast off). vs. 20c (ill. 2 Co. 3:16)
4. The word we included Dr. Luke (the writer of Acts and others aboard,
including Paul see vs.24)

C. Paul encouraged those aboard to take heart. vs.21
1. There was a long abstinence (as going without food fasting, abstinence,
being without appetite for food -- Friberg Lexicon). vs. 21a
2. Paul stood in the midst of them admonishing the captain for not heeding
(follow advice, listen toFriberg Lexicon) his warning. vs.21b
3. Paul encouraged those on board to be of good cheer (to be or to become
encouraged and hence cheerful - 'to be encouraged, to take courage, to
become encouraged Louw Nida) vs.22a
4. Paul encouraged that the ship would not meet with the loss of any mans
life vs.22b
5. Paul stated that the ship would be lossed. vs.22c
6. Paul gave the source of his knowledge. vs. 23
a. Paul received revelation from an angel of the Lord.
b. The angel instructed Paul to (stop) fearing. vs.24
i. The reason he was to stop fearing was that he must (it is a
logical necessity) be brought before Caesar.
ii. The reason he was not to fear was that God had given (to
give, to grant, as a present Reinecker/Rogers ill. Gal.
3:18) him all that were on board.
156
7. Paul urged that he was confident that things would be as he was told. vs.25
8. Paul warned that it was told him that they would be cast upon (as a
nautical technical term, of ships drift off course, be driven onto rocks, run
aground Friberg Lexicon) a certain island. vs.26

D. The fourteenth night of the ships distress brought possibilities of an end. vs. 27-29
1. The ship was driven up and down in the Adria(the Adriatic Sea, i. e., in
a wide sense, the sea between Greece and Italy).
2. The shipmen deemed (u:e |eta -- to have an opinion based on scant
evidence, often with the implication of regarding a false opinion as true
'to imagine, to conjecture, to suspect) about midnight that they were
drawing near to some country.
3. The shipmen sounded (et,. -- to use a rope with a lead weight attached
to it in order to measure the depth of water - 'to take soundings, to heave
the lead, to drop a plummet) vs.28
4. The shipmen found the depth of the water to be 20 fathoms (e,uta --
traditionally the measurement of a man's arms stretched out horizontally,
reckoned at approximately six feet or almost two meters and used as a
technical, nautical term to measure the depth of water)
5. The depth of the water left them fearing that they would fall upon the
rocks (run aground upon uneven places; of a rocky seashore). vs.29
a. They cast four anchors out of the stern
b. They wished (to speak to or to make requests of God - 'to pray, to
speak to God, to ask God for, prayer Louw-Nida) for the day.

E. God used Paul during the dire circumstances that led many on the ship to attempt to
flee for their lives. vs.30
1. The shipmen tried to flee the ship.
a. They made their attempt by letting down the boat under colour (to
pretend to be engaged in a particular activity - 'to pretend, pretense
Louw--Nida)
b. They pretended to cast anchors (the cable to which the anchor is
fastened, i. e. to cast anchor (the idea of extending the cables runs
into that of carrying out and dropping the anchors Joseph Thayer)
out of the foreship
2. Paul warned that their attempt to leave the vessel would result in their death.
vs.31-32
a. Paul warned the Centurion and the soldiers.
b. The Centurion and the soldiers listened to Paul and cut the ropes of
the boat they were trying to escape in and let her fall.
3. Paul the prisoner served as an encourager in the midst of the event. vs.33
a. He besought (to exhort; beg) those aboard to take meat.
b. He assured them that not a hair (shall) fall from the head on any of
them. vs.34
c. Paul took the lead by taking bread and giving thanks to God.
i. Paul gave thanks in the presence (something is supposed to
157
be done by one while standing or appearing in the presence
of another Joseph Thayer) of them all.
ii. Paul began to eat.
d. Pauls exhortation to them was effective as they came to be of good
cheer. vs.36
c. They all took some meat.
4. There were two-hundred and 76 souls (individuals) on board.
5. Those aboard ate enough.
6. After eating (satiate, fill; passive get enough of, be satisfied with, have all
one wants of something Friberg Lexicon) enough they cast out
(seu|t,. -- to cause something to weigh less - 'to lighten, to make less
heavy Louw-Nida) the wheat into the sea.


III. PAULS VESSEL RUNS AGROUND ON THE ISLAND OF MALTA. vs. 39-44
A. Daylight increased the hope that they would be saved. vs.39
1. They knew not (have a full experiential knowledge of) the land.
2. They discovered a certain creek (an inward extension of a sea bay, inlet)
with a shore(the shore of the sea, beach).
3. They were minded (saa|e.. -- to give very careful consideration to
some matter - 'to think about very carefully, to consider closely) to thrust
(to propel, driveLouw-Nida) the ship (aground) into the creek (if they
were able to control it).

B. The crew tried to gain control of the vessel by: vs.40
1. Lifting (to take away that which surrounds or envelops a thing Joseph
Thayer) the anchors.
2. They committed (to give up, let go, leave; they let down into the sea; i. e.,
abandoned Joseph Thayer) themselves to the sea.
3. They, simultaneous to lifting the anchors, loosed the rudder bands
(ropes employed in linking two rudders of a boat Louw-Nida)
4. They hoisted up the mainsail (a. .| -- a cloth attached above a boat
in such a way as to catch the wind and thus propel the boat through the
water - 'sail) to the wind.
5. They made toward the shore.

C. Making it to the sea did not the ship ran aground where the two seas met.
1. On the one hand, the forepart (the bow) stuck fast and remained
unmoveable (became jammed fast Louw-Nida).
2. On the other hand, the hinder (back) part was broken with the violence
of the waves.

D. The ship running aground caused alarm for the soldiers who were concerned about
prisoners escaping. vs.42-43
1. Guards were responsible for those in the custody. ill. Acts 12:19; 16:27
2. The soldiers counsel (or better translated, there came to be a
158
determination among the soldiers) was to kill the prisoners so they wouldnt
escape.
3. God intervened in the soldiers determination by causing the centurion to be
willing (determining for himself) to save Paul.
a. The centurion kept(forbid) the soldiers from their purpose
(determination).
b. The centurion commanded those who could swim to cast (jump
overboard) into the sea and get to shore.
4. Those who couldnt swim made it to shore by other means. vs.44a
a. Some made it to shore on boards (planks from the ship).
b. Some made it to shore on pieces of the ship
5. All made it safe (in the passive voice it can be translated all were saved
upon the land). vs.44b

































159


CHAPTER 28


I. GOD USED PAUL TO GENERATE KINDNESS FROM THE ISLANDERS TO ALL ON
BOARD THE SHIP. vs.1-10
A. The ship crashed on an Island called Malta.
Note: an island in the Mediterranean, the modern Malta. Here the ship in which Paul was
being conveyed a prisoner to Rome was wrecked. The bay in which it was wrecked now bears
the name of "St. Paul's Bay", "a certain creek with a shore." It is about 2 miles deep and 1
broad, and the whole physical condition of the scene answers the description of the shipwreck
given in Ac 28:1

B. The people on the Island were barbarous (The Greeks used a ae, of any
foreigner ignorant of the Greek language and the Greek culture, whether mental
or moral, with the added notion, after the Persian war, of rudeness and brutality.
Hence, the word is applied in the N. T., but not reproachfully, in Acts 28:2,4, to
the inhabitants of Malta (i. e. \.t , which see), who were of Phoenician or
Punic origin; and to those nations that had, indeed, some refinement of manners
Joseph Thayer).
1. They showed (supply, grant something to someone Friberg
Lexicon)
2. The word kindness is the English word philanthrophy (|ta|.:t a| -- as
a friendly disposition toward people goodness, friendliness, love for
mankind; as a humane action hospitality, kindness Friberg Lexicon)
1. They showed their kindness by kindling (to cause the process of
burning to begin - 'to ignite, to kindle, to set ablaze, to start a fire, to
light a lamp. Louw-Nida)
3. The received (welcomed) because of the rain and the cold.


C. The barbarous people were very superstitious. vs. 3-6
1. They thought Paul to be a murderer when a viper fastened (to lay hold of,
fasten on Joseph Thayer) to his hand. vs.4a
2. The word vengeance is Dike -- the goddess J ustice, avenging justice
Joseph Thayer. vs.4b
3. Paul shook the viper off and felt no harm (suffered no evil) vs.5
4. The barbarians looked (to await with apprehension concerning impending
danger or trouble - 'to wait with apprehension, to wait with anxiety Louw-
Nida) vs.6
a. They waited to see if he would have swollen (burn with fever;
swell up from inflammation Louw-Nida).
b. They waited to see if he would have fallen down.
c. They saw (to he a spectator, look at, beholdJoseph Thayer)
d. When no harm came to Paul they changed their mind and said he was
a god.
160


D. Publius (Grk: Poplios, from the Latin praenomen Publius, derived from populus,
"popular"; according to Ramsay it is the Greek form of the Latin nomen
Popilius) was the chief man (the Greek title meaning "first," applied to Publius
in Acts 28:7, was an official one, and has been found on an inscription from the
island of Gaulus near Malta; Publius held office under the governor of Sicily. As
the leading official in Malta, he was responsible for any Roman soldiers and their
prisoners who might land there) of the island.

E. Pauls healing of Publius father opened the floodgates for many seeking healing
from him. vs.9
1. His father was sick with a fever.
2. His father was sick with a bloody flux (euc.|. te| a common and
dangerous disease which in Malta is often fatal to soldiers of the garrison
even at the present day. It is also prevalent in Palestine at certain seasons,
and in Egypt its mortality was formerly about 36 percent. Its older name
was due to the d ischarge of blood from the intestine. Sometimes portions of
the bowel become gangrenous and slough I.S.B.E.)
3. Paul did two things to heal Publius father:
1. He prayed.
2. He laid his hands on him.
4. The rest of those with diseases came to be healed. vs.9

F. The islanders helped the shipwrecked passengers with the things necessary to resume
their travel. vs.10



II. PAUL RESUMED HIS TRIP TO ROME THREE MONTHS LATER. vs. 11-15
A. Paul and the other passengers spent three months on Malta. vs.11

B. The boarded an Alexandria ship whose sign (strictly, of a distinguishing mark;
hence, of a ship on which a figurehead is mounted distinguished or marked (by),
carrying an emblem; neuter as a substantive emblem, figurehead, carved figure
Friberg Lexicon)

C. The term Castor denotes Dioscuri, meaning heavenly twins, name of Greek gods
Castor and Pollux, twin sons of Zeus and Leda, regarded as patrons of sailors
Friberg Lexicon

D. They sailed from Malta to Syracuse. vs.12

E. They fetched a compass (the idea of encircling or "fetching a compass" (the
King J ames Version) is expressed by the phrase "to make a circuit -- Easton
Dictionary) and traveled into Rehegium and the next day into Puteoli. vs.13-15
161
1. Paul and his company found believers in Puteoli.
2. Paul and the others exhorted them to remain with them for seven days.
3. Paul took courage (ace,-- an idiom, literally 'to take courage; to become
confident or courageous in the face of real or possible danger - 'to become
confident, to take courage Joseph Thayer) because of the brethren.vs.15


III. GOD USES PAUL TO MINISTER TWO YEARS IN ROME. vs.16-31
A. The centurion showed Paul kindness once again by distinguishing him differently
from the other prisoners. vs.16
1. He gave the prisoners to the captain of the guard.
2. He allowed Paul to dwell (abide, remain) by himself together with a
soldier.

B. Paul assembled the chief of the Jews of Rome together to make his defense. vs.17
1. Paul establishes that he had committed nothing against (opposed as an
adversary, hostile, antagonistic in feeling or act -- Joseph Thayer) the
people.
2. Paul establishes that he had committed nothing against the customs (a
pattern of behavior more or less fixed by tradition and generally
sanctioned by the society - 'custom, habit Louw-Nida) ill. Acts 21:21
of the fathers.
3. Paul noted that even in spite of the two afore-mentioned facts, he was
delivered prisoner.
4. Proof of Pauls innocence was that the Romans examined (a|ast|. -- to
try to learn the nature or truth of something by the process of careful study,
evaluation and judgment - 'to examine carefully, to investigate, to study
thoroughly) him and found no cause for death. vs.18

C. Paul expresses the reason for his presence in Rome. vs.19
1. The Jews spoke against (contradict, speak against, refute) his release. ill.
Acts 13:45; Tit. 1:9
2. Paul was constrained (e. .-- to compel someone to act in a particular
manner - 'to compel, to force-- Louw-Nida) to appeal to Caesar.
3. Paul assured the Jews that he had no aught (not as though, like) to accuse
my nation.

D. Paul states that it was on the basis of the Hope of Israel that he was in
chains. vs.20
1. He called for the Jews to see and speak to them because of his being forced
to appeal to Caesar (Paul did not want there to be any question as to whether
he had a problem with Israel).
2. Paul asserts that it is because of the hope of Israel (Christ) that he was
imprisoned.

E. The Jews were ignorant of the issues that Paul addressed concerning his problems in
162
Jerusalem. vs. 21
1. They had never received letters out of Judea concerning Paul.
2. They had not had any of the brethren come and spake any harm
(porneros evil, none of the Jews visiting Jerusalem had accused Paul of
conspiring against the Nation Israel for purposes that were lacking in
character) concerning Paul.

F. The Jews desired (to consider something of a comparable merit or worth - 'to
regard as worthy of, to consider as meriting, to regard as being valuable for
Louw-Nida) to hear Pauls message. vs.22
1. They wanted to know what Paul thinkest (reflectively think)
2. They indicated that the sect (a division or group based upon different
doctrinal opinions and/or loyalties and hence by implication in certain
contexts an unjustified party or group (applicable in the NT to religious
parties) - 'religious party Louw-Nida -- ill. Acts 24:5) was spoken against
everywhere.

G. The Jews appointed (to assign someone to a particular task, function, or role
'to appoint, to designate, to assign, to give a task to Louw-Nida) him a day in
which to speak. vs.23 (ill. Lk. 24:44)
1. Many came to his lodging.
2. Paul expounded (.st t-- to put or place something out of an area - 'to
put out of Louw-Nida) and testified (etaau eat-- to make a serious
declaration on the basis of presumed personal knowledge Louw-Nida
ill. Acts 20:26; 18:5) the kingdom of God.
a. Paul persuaded them concerning Jesus out of the law of Moses. (ill.
Lk. 24:44-47; Acts 26:22-23)
b. Paul persuaded them concerning Jesus out of the prophets, from
morning till evening. (Is. 53; Ps.22)

H. Paul had mixed success with his message to the Jews. vs.24
1. Some believed the things that were spoken.
2. Some believed not (were not persuaded; were faithless) concerning the
things spoken.

J. Paul rebuked them for their unbelief quoting the 6
th
chapter of Isaiah concerning the
Jews rejection of Messiah. vs. 25b-27a
1. Hearing, ye shall hear and shall not understand (put things together)
2. Seeing (glancing) ye shall see, and not perceive (see with perception of
thought)
3. For the heart of this people is waxed gross (of mental comprehension
with difficulty, dully, stupidly Friberg Lexicon ill. MT 13.15).
4. Their ears are dull of hearing
5. Their eyes have they closed (to be unwilling to learn and to evaluate
something fairly - 'to refuse to learn, to refuse to recognize. Louw Nida)

163
K. Isaiah explains why the Jews were blind and deaf: vs.27b
1. Lest they should see with their eyes
2. Lest they should hear with their ears
3. Lest they should understand with their heart
a. In which case they would be converted (turn).
b. In which case they would be healed

L. Paul declares to the Jews that two things has happened because of their rejection:
vs.28
1. Salvation has been sent to the Gentiles.
2. The Gentiles will hear it.

M. Pauls quotation left the Jews with great reasoning (debates) among themselves.
vs.29

N. Paul dwelt in Rome for two years. vs. 30
1. He lived in his own hired house (rented house).
2. He received all that came in unto him.
3. He continued, preaching the Kingdom of God. vs.31
4. He continued teaching those things which concern the Lord Jesus Christ.
a. Paul taught concerning the Lord with all confidence.
b. Paul taught concerning the Lord with no man forbidding (hindered)
him.

Вам также может понравиться